NZ621078B2 - Substituted (e)-n'-(1-phenylethylidene) benzohydrazide analogs as histone demethylase inhibitors - Google Patents
Substituted (e)-n'-(1-phenylethylidene) benzohydrazide analogs as histone demethylase inhibitors Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- NZ621078B2 NZ621078B2 NZ621078A NZ62107812A NZ621078B2 NZ 621078 B2 NZ621078 B2 NZ 621078B2 NZ 621078 A NZ621078 A NZ 621078A NZ 62107812 A NZ62107812 A NZ 62107812A NZ 621078 B2 NZ621078 B2 NZ 621078B2
- Authority
- NZ
- New Zealand
- Prior art keywords
- compound
- compounds
- further aspect
- cancer
- disclosed
- Prior art date
Links
- 101700064880 MBD2 Proteins 0.000 title claims abstract description 80
- 102100008691 MBD2 Human genes 0.000 title claims abstract description 80
- 230000002401 inhibitory effect Effects 0.000 title abstract description 90
- 239000003112 inhibitor Substances 0.000 title abstract description 27
- 150000001875 compounds Chemical class 0.000 claims abstract description 555
- -1 (E)-N'-(1-phenylethylidene) benzohydrazide analogue compounds Chemical class 0.000 claims abstract description 151
- 230000000694 effects Effects 0.000 claims description 107
- 201000010099 disease Diseases 0.000 claims description 104
- 239000003814 drug Substances 0.000 claims description 63
- 239000011780 sodium chloride Substances 0.000 claims description 54
- 150000003839 salts Chemical class 0.000 claims description 52
- 239000008194 pharmaceutical composition Substances 0.000 claims description 49
- 230000001413 cellular Effects 0.000 claims description 43
- 241000124008 Mammalia Species 0.000 claims description 42
- 230000035755 proliferation Effects 0.000 claims description 39
- 229910052739 hydrogen Inorganic materials 0.000 claims description 34
- 239000001257 hydrogen Substances 0.000 claims description 31
- 239000003937 drug carrier Substances 0.000 claims description 24
- 238000004519 manufacturing process Methods 0.000 claims description 22
- 125000004435 hydrogen atoms Chemical group [H]* 0.000 claims description 21
- 125000002887 hydroxy group Chemical group [H]O* 0.000 claims description 19
- 125000004169 (C1-C6) alkyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 17
- 230000003247 decreasing Effects 0.000 claims description 14
- 125000000592 heterocycloalkyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 10
- 125000005913 (C3-C6) cycloalkyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 9
- 125000001188 haloalkyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 9
- 125000001475 halogen functional group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 9
- 125000004191 (C1-C6) alkoxy group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 8
- 125000000171 (C1-C6) haloalkyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 8
- 125000006685 (C1-C6) polyhaloalkyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 8
- 125000004093 cyano group Chemical group *C#N 0.000 claims description 8
- 125000006684 polyhaloalkyl group Polymers 0.000 claims description 8
- 125000002924 primary amino group Chemical group [H]N([H])* 0.000 claims description 8
- 125000002393 azetidinyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 6
- 125000004069 aziridinyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 6
- 125000006274 (C1-C3)alkoxy group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 4
- LAPGMTOHOQPDGI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4-amino-2,5-difluorobenzonitrile Chemical group NC1=CC(F)=C(C#N)C=C1F LAPGMTOHOQPDGI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 claims description 4
- 125000005233 alkylalcohol group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 4
- 125000003725 azepanyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 4
- 125000002632 imidazolidinyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 4
- 125000002757 morpholinyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 4
- 125000000160 oxazolidinyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 4
- 125000004193 piperazinyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 4
- 125000003386 piperidinyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 4
- 125000003072 pyrazolidinyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 4
- 125000000719 pyrrolidinyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 4
- 125000006273 (C1-C3) alkyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 2
- 125000004183 alkoxy alkyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 2
- 201000011510 cancer Diseases 0.000 abstract description 144
- 239000004472 Lysine Substances 0.000 abstract description 25
- PEYICPGMNKIWNB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-[[1-(3-chloro-6-oxocyclohexa-2,4-dien-1-ylidene)ethylamino]carbamoyl]-N-methylbenzenesulfonamide Chemical compound CNS(=O)(=O)C1=CC=CC(C(=O)NNC(C)=C2C(C=CC(Cl)=C2)=O)=C1 PEYICPGMNKIWNB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 abstract 1
- ZVVCYRYDHNYAPV-UHFFFAOYSA-N N'-[1-(3-chloro-6-oxocyclohexa-2,4-dien-1-ylidene)ethyl]-3-morpholin-4-ylsulfonylbenzohydrazide Chemical compound C1=C(Cl)C=CC(=O)C1=C(C)NNC(=O)C(C=1)=CC=CC=1S(=O)(=O)N1CCOCC1 ZVVCYRYDHNYAPV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 abstract 1
- 102000010909 EC 1.4.3.4 Human genes 0.000 description 167
- 108010062431 EC 1.4.3.4 Proteins 0.000 description 167
- 238000006243 chemical reaction Methods 0.000 description 150
- OKKJLVBELUTLKV-UHFFFAOYSA-N methanol Chemical compound OC OKKJLVBELUTLKV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 134
- 239000000203 mixture Substances 0.000 description 105
- QTBSBXVTEAMEQO-UHFFFAOYSA-N acetic acid Chemical compound CC(O)=O QTBSBXVTEAMEQO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 84
- 102100019858 KDM1B Human genes 0.000 description 83
- 101700069193 KDM1B Proteins 0.000 description 83
- 239000002904 solvent Substances 0.000 description 81
- 238000002360 preparation method Methods 0.000 description 74
- 230000027455 binding Effects 0.000 description 60
- 210000004027 cells Anatomy 0.000 description 56
- VAYOSLLFUXYJDT-RDTXWAMCSA-N LSD Chemical compound C1=CC(C=2[C@H](N(C)C[C@@H](C=2)C(=O)N(CC)CC)C2)=C3C2=CNC3=C1 VAYOSLLFUXYJDT-RDTXWAMCSA-N 0.000 description 47
- 239000007787 solid Substances 0.000 description 47
- 229950002454 Lysergide Drugs 0.000 description 46
- 125000000217 alkyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 46
- 238000001816 cooling Methods 0.000 description 43
- 229940079593 drugs Drugs 0.000 description 42
- 206010028980 Neoplasm Diseases 0.000 description 40
- 125000004432 carbon atoms Chemical group C* 0.000 description 40
- 238000003818 flash chromatography Methods 0.000 description 40
- OAKJQQAXSVQMHS-UHFFFAOYSA-N hydrazine Chemical compound NN OAKJQQAXSVQMHS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 40
- 239000000463 material Substances 0.000 description 39
- IJGRMHOSHXDMSA-UHFFFAOYSA-N nitrogen Chemical compound N#N IJGRMHOSHXDMSA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 39
- 230000035492 administration Effects 0.000 description 38
- 239000000460 chlorine Substances 0.000 description 38
- 125000001424 substituent group Chemical group 0.000 description 36
- 125000003118 aryl group Chemical group 0.000 description 32
- 239000004480 active ingredient Substances 0.000 description 31
- 230000004064 dysfunction Effects 0.000 description 31
- 102000004169 proteins and genes Human genes 0.000 description 31
- 108090000623 proteins and genes Proteins 0.000 description 31
- 239000011541 reaction mixture Substances 0.000 description 31
- 238000002330 electrospray ionisation mass spectrometry Methods 0.000 description 29
- 238000005160 1H NMR spectroscopy Methods 0.000 description 28
- 238000003032 molecular docking Methods 0.000 description 27
- 239000003054 catalyst Substances 0.000 description 26
- 125000000753 cycloalkyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 26
- 229910052736 halogen Inorganic materials 0.000 description 26
- 239000000126 substance Substances 0.000 description 26
- 150000002367 halogens Chemical class 0.000 description 24
- 229910052757 nitrogen Inorganic materials 0.000 description 23
- 150000003254 radicals Chemical class 0.000 description 22
- 239000012453 solvate Substances 0.000 description 22
- KDXKERNSBIXSRK-YFKPBYRVSA-N L-lysine Chemical compound NCCCC[C@H](N)C(O)=O KDXKERNSBIXSRK-YFKPBYRVSA-N 0.000 description 21
- 229910052799 carbon Inorganic materials 0.000 description 21
- 125000000392 cycloalkenyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 21
- 125000005842 heteroatoms Chemical group 0.000 description 21
- 230000003993 interaction Effects 0.000 description 20
- 239000000969 carrier Substances 0.000 description 19
- 239000003795 chemical substances by application Substances 0.000 description 19
- 238000004440 column chromatography Methods 0.000 description 19
- 125000001072 heteroaryl group Chemical group 0.000 description 19
- 229910052760 oxygen Inorganic materials 0.000 description 19
- XTGCUDZCCIRWHL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-(5-chloro-2-hydroxyphenyl)ethanone Chemical compound CC(=O)C1=CC(Cl)=CC=C1O XTGCUDZCCIRWHL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 18
- 125000004429 atoms Chemical group 0.000 description 18
- 239000000306 component Substances 0.000 description 18
- HEDRZPFGACZZDS-MICDWDOJSA-N deuterated chloroform Substances [2H]C(Cl)(Cl)Cl HEDRZPFGACZZDS-MICDWDOJSA-N 0.000 description 18
- QAOWNCQODCNURD-UHFFFAOYSA-N sulfuric acid Substances OS(O)(=O)=O QAOWNCQODCNURD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 18
- 229940093632 Flavin-Adenine Dinucleotide Drugs 0.000 description 17
- 125000003342 alkenyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 17
- 125000000304 alkynyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 17
- VWWQXMAJTJZDQX-UYBVJOGSSA-N flavin adenine dinucleotide Chemical compound C1=NC2=C(N)N=CN=C2N1[C@@H]([C@H](O)[C@@H]1O)O[C@@H]1CO[P@](O)(=O)O[P@@](O)(=O)OC[C@@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@@H](O)CN1C2=NC(=O)NC(=O)C2=NC2=C1C=C(C)C(C)=C2 VWWQXMAJTJZDQX-UYBVJOGSSA-N 0.000 description 17
- 235000019162 flavin adenine dinucleotide Nutrition 0.000 description 17
- 239000011714 flavin adenine dinucleotide Substances 0.000 description 17
- 239000001301 oxygen Substances 0.000 description 17
- MYMOFIZGZYHOMD-UHFFFAOYSA-N oxygen Chemical compound O=O MYMOFIZGZYHOMD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 17
- 229910052717 sulfur Inorganic materials 0.000 description 17
- 239000003826 tablet Substances 0.000 description 17
- 210000000481 Breast Anatomy 0.000 description 16
- 102000004190 Enzymes Human genes 0.000 description 16
- 108090000790 Enzymes Proteins 0.000 description 16
- 239000002609 media Substances 0.000 description 16
- NINIDFKCEFEMDL-UHFFFAOYSA-N sulfur Chemical compound [S] NINIDFKCEFEMDL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 16
- 239000011593 sulfur Substances 0.000 description 16
- XLYOFNOQVPJJNP-UHFFFAOYSA-N water Substances O XLYOFNOQVPJJNP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 16
- 238000004166 bioassay Methods 0.000 description 15
- 238000000034 method Methods 0.000 description 15
- 125000003545 alkoxy group Chemical group 0.000 description 14
- OKTJSMMVPCPJKN-UHFFFAOYSA-N carbon Chemical compound [C] OKTJSMMVPCPJKN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 14
- LFQSCWFLJHTTHZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N ethanol Chemical compound CCO LFQSCWFLJHTTHZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 14
- 206010006187 Breast cancer Diseases 0.000 description 13
- 230000017858 demethylation Effects 0.000 description 13
- 238000010520 demethylation reaction Methods 0.000 description 13
- RTZKZFJDLAIYFH-UHFFFAOYSA-N diethyl ether Chemical compound CCOCC RTZKZFJDLAIYFH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 13
- 230000014509 gene expression Effects 0.000 description 13
- 125000005843 halogen group Chemical group 0.000 description 13
- 239000007788 liquid Substances 0.000 description 13
- 238000002560 therapeutic procedure Methods 0.000 description 13
- 210000001519 tissues Anatomy 0.000 description 13
- 102000016761 Haem oxygenases Human genes 0.000 description 12
- 108050006318 Haem oxygenases Proteins 0.000 description 12
- 102100000513 KDM1A Human genes 0.000 description 12
- 101700018814 KDM1A Proteins 0.000 description 12
- 241001465754 Metazoa Species 0.000 description 12
- 125000002496 methyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 12
- 230000000051 modifying Effects 0.000 description 12
- 239000000243 solution Substances 0.000 description 12
- WYURNTSHIVDZCO-UHFFFAOYSA-N tetrahydrofuran Chemical compound C1CCOC1 WYURNTSHIVDZCO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 12
- 239000002253 acid Substances 0.000 description 11
- 125000005418 aryl aryl group Chemical group 0.000 description 11
- 125000001309 chloro group Chemical group Cl* 0.000 description 11
- 230000004952 protein activity Effects 0.000 description 11
- 210000004556 Brain Anatomy 0.000 description 10
- 208000000429 Leukemia, Lymphocytic, Chronic, B-Cell Diseases 0.000 description 10
- 210000004072 Lung Anatomy 0.000 description 10
- 210000001672 Ovary Anatomy 0.000 description 10
- 238000004458 analytical method Methods 0.000 description 10
- WARCRYXKINZHGQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N benzohydrazide Chemical class NNC(=O)C1=CC=CC=C1 WARCRYXKINZHGQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 10
- PEDCQBHIVMGVHV-UHFFFAOYSA-N glycerine Chemical compound OCC(O)CO PEDCQBHIVMGVHV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 10
- PCHJSUWPFVWCPO-UHFFFAOYSA-N gold Chemical compound [Au] PCHJSUWPFVWCPO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 10
- HQKMJHAJHXVSDF-UHFFFAOYSA-L magnesium stearate Chemical compound [Mg+2].CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC([O-])=O.CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC([O-])=O HQKMJHAJHXVSDF-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 10
- FWIFKKUOURUDNG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-morpholin-4-ylsulfonylbenzohydrazide Chemical compound NNC(=O)C1=CC=CC(S(=O)(=O)N2CCOCC2)=C1 FWIFKKUOURUDNG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 9
- 210000002307 Prostate Anatomy 0.000 description 9
- 206010039491 Sarcoma Diseases 0.000 description 9
- 125000001931 aliphatic group Chemical group 0.000 description 9
- 230000010261 cell growth Effects 0.000 description 9
- 238000004587 chromatography analysis Methods 0.000 description 9
- 239000003085 diluting agent Substances 0.000 description 9
- 150000002148 esters Chemical class 0.000 description 9
- 235000019441 ethanol Nutrition 0.000 description 9
- 229910052737 gold Inorganic materials 0.000 description 9
- 239000010931 gold Substances 0.000 description 9
- 150000004820 halides Chemical class 0.000 description 9
- YNAVUWVOSKDBBP-UHFFFAOYSA-N morpholine Chemical compound C1COCCN1 YNAVUWVOSKDBBP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 9
- 230000002265 prevention Effects 0.000 description 9
- 230000001225 therapeutic Effects 0.000 description 9
- IAZDPXIOMUYVGZ-WFGJKAKNSA-N DMSO-d6 Chemical compound [2H]C([2H])([2H])S(=O)C([2H])([2H])[2H] IAZDPXIOMUYVGZ-WFGJKAKNSA-N 0.000 description 8
- 229940110715 ENZYMES FOR TREATMENT OF WOUNDS AND ULCERS Drugs 0.000 description 8
- 229940088598 Enzyme Drugs 0.000 description 8
- 210000001550 Testis Anatomy 0.000 description 8
- OKKJLVBELUTLKV-MZCSYVLQSA-N cd3od Chemical compound [2H]OC([2H])([2H])[2H] OKKJLVBELUTLKV-MZCSYVLQSA-N 0.000 description 8
- 239000003153 chemical reaction reagent Substances 0.000 description 8
- IAZDPXIOMUYVGZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N dimethylsulphoxide Chemical compound CS(C)=O IAZDPXIOMUYVGZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 8
- 239000002552 dosage form Substances 0.000 description 8
- 125000001495 ethyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 8
- 230000001965 increased Effects 0.000 description 8
- 230000001404 mediated Effects 0.000 description 8
- 230000011987 methylation Effects 0.000 description 8
- 238000007069 methylation reaction Methods 0.000 description 8
- 230000004048 modification Effects 0.000 description 8
- 238000006011 modification reaction Methods 0.000 description 8
- 230000001575 pathological Effects 0.000 description 8
- 229920000728 polyester Polymers 0.000 description 8
- BWHMMNNQKKPAPP-UHFFFAOYSA-L potassium carbonate Chemical compound [K+].[K+].[O-]C([O-])=O BWHMMNNQKKPAPP-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 8
- 125000002577 pseudohalo group Chemical group 0.000 description 8
- 230000001603 reducing Effects 0.000 description 8
- 150000003573 thiols Chemical class 0.000 description 8
- 206010025323 Lymphomas Diseases 0.000 description 7
- 206010053643 Neurodegenerative disease Diseases 0.000 description 7
- 206010025310 Other lymphomas Diseases 0.000 description 7
- 125000003277 amino group Chemical group 0.000 description 7
- 230000037396 body weight Effects 0.000 description 7
- 125000001246 bromo group Chemical group Br* 0.000 description 7
- 239000002775 capsule Substances 0.000 description 7
- 229910052801 chlorine Inorganic materials 0.000 description 7
- 230000002354 daily Effects 0.000 description 7
- 238000001952 enzyme assay Methods 0.000 description 7
- 230000012010 growth Effects 0.000 description 7
- 150000002894 organic compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 7
- OAICVXFJPJFONN-UHFFFAOYSA-N phosphorus Chemical compound [P] OAICVXFJPJFONN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 7
- 229910052698 phosphorus Inorganic materials 0.000 description 7
- 239000011574 phosphorus Substances 0.000 description 7
- 230000003405 preventing Effects 0.000 description 7
- 239000000725 suspension Substances 0.000 description 7
- AELCINSCMGFISI-DTWKUNHWSA-N (1R,2S)-2-phenylcyclopropan-1-amine Chemical compound N[C@@H]1C[C@H]1C1=CC=CC=C1 AELCINSCMGFISI-DTWKUNHWSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 210000004369 Blood Anatomy 0.000 description 6
- 206010008958 Chronic lymphocytic leukaemia Diseases 0.000 description 6
- 241000272184 Falconiformes Species 0.000 description 6
- 241000282326 Felis catus Species 0.000 description 6
- 210000003734 Kidney Anatomy 0.000 description 6
- 206010029592 Non-Hodgkin's lymphomas Diseases 0.000 description 6
- 210000000496 Pancreas Anatomy 0.000 description 6
- FDDDEECHVMSUSB-UHFFFAOYSA-N Sulfanilamide Chemical compound NC1=CC=C(S(N)(=O)=O)C=C1 FDDDEECHVMSUSB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 230000033228 biological regulation Effects 0.000 description 6
- 239000008280 blood Substances 0.000 description 6
- 201000008275 breast carcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 6
- ZAMOUSCENKQFHK-UHFFFAOYSA-N chlorine atom Chemical compound [Cl] ZAMOUSCENKQFHK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- KRKNYBCHXYNGOX-UHFFFAOYSA-N citric acid Chemical compound OC(=O)CC(O)(C(O)=O)CC(O)=O KRKNYBCHXYNGOX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 125000001559 cyclopropyl group Chemical group [H]C1([H])C([H])([H])C1([H])* 0.000 description 6
- 230000002559 cytogenic Effects 0.000 description 6
- 239000006185 dispersion Substances 0.000 description 6
- 238000002474 experimental method Methods 0.000 description 6
- 229910052731 fluorine Inorganic materials 0.000 description 6
- 125000000524 functional group Chemical group 0.000 description 6
- 150000002429 hydrazines Chemical class 0.000 description 6
- UFHFLCQGNIYNRP-UHFFFAOYSA-N hydrogen Chemical compound [H][H] UFHFLCQGNIYNRP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 238000002513 implantation Methods 0.000 description 6
- 239000004615 ingredient Substances 0.000 description 6
- 125000001449 isopropyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])(*)C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 6
- YMWUJEATGCHHMB-UHFFFAOYSA-N methylene dichloride Chemical compound ClCCl YMWUJEATGCHHMB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 150000002825 nitriles Chemical class 0.000 description 6
- 239000000843 powder Substances 0.000 description 6
- VYPSYNLAJGMNEJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N silicium dioxide Chemical compound O=[Si]=O VYPSYNLAJGMNEJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 238000006467 substitution reaction Methods 0.000 description 6
- 229960001663 sulfanilamide Drugs 0.000 description 6
- 238000010189 synthetic method Methods 0.000 description 6
- 229960003741 tranylcypromine Drugs 0.000 description 6
- 208000009956 Adenocarcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 5
- BVKZGUZCCUSVTD-UHFFFAOYSA-N Carbonic acid Chemical compound OC(O)=O BVKZGUZCCUSVTD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- 210000001072 Colon Anatomy 0.000 description 5
- 210000001035 Gastrointestinal Tract Anatomy 0.000 description 5
- 102000002737 Heme Oxygenase-1 Human genes 0.000 description 5
- 108010018924 Heme Oxygenase-1 Proteins 0.000 description 5
- GUBGYTABKSRVRQ-UUNJERMWSA-N Lactose Natural products O([C@@H]1[C@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@H](O)O[C@@H]1CO)[C@H]1[C@@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@H](CO)O1 GUBGYTABKSRVRQ-UUNJERMWSA-N 0.000 description 5
- 206010024324 Leukaemias Diseases 0.000 description 5
- 210000004324 Lymphatic System Anatomy 0.000 description 5
- 241000699666 Mus <mouse, genus> Species 0.000 description 5
- 210000000664 Rectum Anatomy 0.000 description 5
- 210000003491 Skin Anatomy 0.000 description 5
- 210000002784 Stomach Anatomy 0.000 description 5
- 238000007792 addition Methods 0.000 description 5
- 239000002671 adjuvant Substances 0.000 description 5
- 230000000240 adjuvant Effects 0.000 description 5
- 150000001299 aldehydes Chemical class 0.000 description 5
- 238000010171 animal model Methods 0.000 description 5
- IVRMZWNICZWHMI-UHFFFAOYSA-N azide Chemical compound [N-]=[N+]=[N-] IVRMZWNICZWHMI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- 239000002585 base Substances 0.000 description 5
- 238000010256 biochemical assay Methods 0.000 description 5
- KXDHJXZQYSOELW-UHFFFAOYSA-N carbamate Chemical compound NC(O)=O KXDHJXZQYSOELW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- 239000011203 carbon fibre reinforced carbon Substances 0.000 description 5
- 201000009030 carcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 5
- 125000001995 cyclobutyl group Chemical group [H]C1([H])C([H])([H])C([H])(*)C1([H])[H] 0.000 description 5
- 230000001419 dependent Effects 0.000 description 5
- 238000009472 formulation Methods 0.000 description 5
- 125000000623 heterocyclic group Chemical group 0.000 description 5
- 238000000338 in vitro Methods 0.000 description 5
- 230000001939 inductive effect Effects 0.000 description 5
- 125000002346 iodo group Chemical group I* 0.000 description 5
- 125000000959 isobutyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 5
- GUBGYTABKSRVRQ-XLOQQCSPSA-N lactose Chemical compound O[C@@H]1[C@@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O[C@H]1O[C@@H]1[C@@H](CO)O[C@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@H]1O GUBGYTABKSRVRQ-XLOQQCSPSA-N 0.000 description 5
- 239000008101 lactose Substances 0.000 description 5
- 239000003446 ligand Substances 0.000 description 5
- 235000019359 magnesium stearate Nutrition 0.000 description 5
- 229940113083 morpholine Drugs 0.000 description 5
- 125000004108 n-butyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 5
- 125000004123 n-propyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 5
- QJGQUHMNIGDVPM-UHFFFAOYSA-N nitrogen group Chemical group [N] QJGQUHMNIGDVPM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- 230000003000 nontoxic Effects 0.000 description 5
- 231100000252 nontoxic Toxicity 0.000 description 5
- 239000002674 ointment Substances 0.000 description 5
- 230000003389 potentiating Effects 0.000 description 5
- JUJWROOIHBZHMG-UHFFFAOYSA-N pyridine Chemical compound C1=CC=NC=C1 JUJWROOIHBZHMG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- FAPWRFPIFSIZLT-UHFFFAOYSA-M sodium chloride Chemical compound [Na+].[Cl-] FAPWRFPIFSIZLT-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 5
- 241000894007 species Species 0.000 description 5
- 125000000547 substituted alkyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 5
- 239000000758 substrate Substances 0.000 description 5
- 125000000999 tert-butyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C(*)(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 5
- 238000003041 virtual screening Methods 0.000 description 5
- UCSJYZPVAKXKNQ-HZYVHMACSA-N 1-[(1S,2R,3R,4S,5R,6R)-3-carbamimidamido-6-{[(2R,3R,4R,5S)-3-{[(2S,3S,4S,5R,6S)-4,5-dihydroxy-6-(hydroxymethyl)-3-(methylamino)oxan-2-yl]oxy}-4-formyl-4-hydroxy-5-methyloxolan-2-yl]oxy}-2,4,5-trihydroxycyclohexyl]guanidine Chemical compound CN[C@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](CO)O[C@H]1O[C@@H]1[C@](C=O)(O)[C@H](C)O[C@H]1O[C@@H]1[C@@H](NC(N)=N)[C@H](O)[C@@H](NC(N)=N)[C@H](O)[C@H]1O UCSJYZPVAKXKNQ-HZYVHMACSA-N 0.000 description 4
- CSCPPACGZOOCGX-MICDWDOJSA-N 1-deuteriopropan-2-one Chemical compound [2H]CC(C)=O CSCPPACGZOOCGX-MICDWDOJSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 229960000643 Adenine Drugs 0.000 description 4
- GFFGJBXGBJISGV-UHFFFAOYSA-N Adenine Natural products NC1=NC=NC2=C1N=CN2 GFFGJBXGBJISGV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 208000003950 B-Cell Lymphoma Diseases 0.000 description 4
- 210000003719 B-Lymphocytes Anatomy 0.000 description 4
- OKWSPHBCWOLFBP-FYJGNVAPSA-N C=1C(Cl)=CC=C(O)C=1C(/C)=N/NC(=O)C1=CC=CC=C1S(=O)(=O)N1CCOCC1 Chemical compound C=1C(Cl)=CC=C(O)C=1C(/C)=N/NC(=O)C1=CC=CC=C1S(=O)(=O)N1CCOCC1 OKWSPHBCWOLFBP-FYJGNVAPSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 108060001838 CoRest Proteins 0.000 description 4
- 206010018338 Glioma Diseases 0.000 description 4
- VEXZGXHMUGYJMC-UHFFFAOYSA-N HCl Chemical compound Cl VEXZGXHMUGYJMC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- FDGQSTZJBFJUBT-UHFFFAOYSA-N Hypoxanthine Chemical compound O=C1NC=NC2=C1NC=N2 FDGQSTZJBFJUBT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 210000004185 Liver Anatomy 0.000 description 4
- 230000036650 Metabolic stability Effects 0.000 description 4
- HHVIBTZHLRERCL-UHFFFAOYSA-N Methylsulfonylmethane Chemical compound CS(C)(=O)=O HHVIBTZHLRERCL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- JOXIMZWYDAKGHI-UHFFFAOYSA-N P-Toluenesulfonic acid Chemical compound CC1=CC=C(S(O)(=O)=O)C=C1 JOXIMZWYDAKGHI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 206010035226 Plasma cell myeloma Diseases 0.000 description 4
- 206010060862 Prostate cancer Diseases 0.000 description 4
- 239000007759 RPMI Media 1640 Substances 0.000 description 4
- 241000283984 Rodentia Species 0.000 description 4
- 229920002472 Starch Polymers 0.000 description 4
- DHXVGJBLRPWPCS-UHFFFAOYSA-N THP Chemical compound C1CCOCC1 DHXVGJBLRPWPCS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- ITMCEJHCFYSIIV-UHFFFAOYSA-N Trifluoromethanesulfonic acid Chemical compound OS(=O)(=O)C(F)(F)F ITMCEJHCFYSIIV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 239000003377 acid catalyst Substances 0.000 description 4
- 230000004913 activation Effects 0.000 description 4
- OIRDTQYFTABQOQ-KQYNXXCUSA-N adenosine Chemical compound C1=NC=2C(N)=NC=NC=2N1[C@@H]1O[C@H](CO)[C@@H](O)[C@H]1O OIRDTQYFTABQOQ-KQYNXXCUSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 150000001408 amides Chemical class 0.000 description 4
- 150000001412 amines Chemical group 0.000 description 4
- 150000001413 amino acids Chemical class 0.000 description 4
- 239000007864 aqueous solution Substances 0.000 description 4
- CREMABGTGYGIQB-UHFFFAOYSA-N carbon carbon Chemical group C.C CREMABGTGYGIQB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 125000002915 carbonyl group Chemical group [*:2]C([*:1])=O 0.000 description 4
- 238000000423 cell based assay Methods 0.000 description 4
- 125000001511 cyclopentyl group Chemical group [H]C1([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])(*)C1([H])[H] 0.000 description 4
- 229920003013 deoxyribonucleic acid Polymers 0.000 description 4
- 230000002255 enzymatic Effects 0.000 description 4
- 239000011737 fluorine Substances 0.000 description 4
- YCKRFDGAMUMZLT-UHFFFAOYSA-N fluorine atom Chemical compound [F] YCKRFDGAMUMZLT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 125000001153 fluoro group Chemical group F* 0.000 description 4
- 235000011187 glycerol Nutrition 0.000 description 4
- 230000002209 hydrophobic Effects 0.000 description 4
- 238000000099 in vitro assay Methods 0.000 description 4
- 238000001802 infusion Methods 0.000 description 4
- 238000001990 intravenous administration Methods 0.000 description 4
- 229910052740 iodine Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- 230000000670 limiting Effects 0.000 description 4
- 125000003588 lysine group Chemical group [H]N([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])(N([H])[H])C(*)=O 0.000 description 4
- 229910052751 metal Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- AFVFQIVMOAPDHO-UHFFFAOYSA-N methanesulfonic acid Chemical compound CS(O)(=O)=O AFVFQIVMOAPDHO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 125000000740 n-pentyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 4
- UFWIBTONFRDIAS-UHFFFAOYSA-N naphthalene Chemical compound C1=CC=CC2=CC=CC=C21 UFWIBTONFRDIAS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 125000001971 neopentyl group Chemical group [H]C([*])([H])C(C([H])([H])[H])(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 4
- 239000001184 potassium carbonate Substances 0.000 description 4
- 229910000027 potassium carbonate Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- 235000015320 potassium carbonate Nutrition 0.000 description 4
- 229940093956 potassium carbonate Drugs 0.000 description 4
- 230000002335 preservative Effects 0.000 description 4
- 239000003755 preservative agent Substances 0.000 description 4
- DNIAPMSPPWPWGF-UHFFFAOYSA-N propylene glycol Chemical compound CC(O)CO DNIAPMSPPWPWGF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 125000006239 protecting group Chemical class 0.000 description 4
- 238000010992 reflux Methods 0.000 description 4
- 230000001105 regulatory Effects 0.000 description 4
- 230000004044 response Effects 0.000 description 4
- 239000000523 sample Substances 0.000 description 4
- 125000002914 sec-butyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])(*)C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 4
- 101700066475 set1 Proteins 0.000 description 4
- 238000004088 simulation Methods 0.000 description 4
- CDBYLPFSWZWCQE-UHFFFAOYSA-L sodium carbonate Chemical compound [Na+].[Na+].[O-]C([O-])=O CDBYLPFSWZWCQE-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 4
- 235000019698 starch Nutrition 0.000 description 4
- 125000005415 substituted alkoxy group Chemical group 0.000 description 4
- 239000004094 surface-active agent Substances 0.000 description 4
- JOXIMZWYDAKGHI-UHFFFAOYSA-M toluene-4-sulfonate Chemical compound CC1=CC=C(S([O-])(=O)=O)C=C1 JOXIMZWYDAKGHI-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 4
- 230000000699 topical Effects 0.000 description 4
- 230000002103 transcriptional Effects 0.000 description 4
- 125000000026 trimethylsilyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])[Si]([*])(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 4
- HNRMPXKDFBEGFZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2,2-Dimethylbutane Chemical compound CCC(C)(C)C HNRMPXKDFBEGFZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- ZFFMLCVRJBZUDZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2,3-Dimethylbutane Chemical compound CC(C)C(C)C ZFFMLCVRJBZUDZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- XLMXUUQMSMKFMH-UZRURVBFSA-N 2-hydroxyethyl (Z,12R)-12-hydroxyoctadec-9-enoate Chemical compound CCCCCC[C@@H](O)C\C=C/CCCCCCCC(=O)OCCO XLMXUUQMSMKFMH-UZRURVBFSA-N 0.000 description 3
- ZIPRVSWQARHEGU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-(4-methylpiperazin-1-yl)sulfonylbenzohydrazide Chemical compound C1CN(C)CCN1S(=O)(=O)C1=CC=CC(C(=O)NN)=C1 ZIPRVSWQARHEGU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- VJVSNPXBBRHNRF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-(4-methylpiperazin-1-yl)sulfonylbenzoic acid Chemical compound C1CN(C)CCN1S(=O)(=O)C1=CC=CC(C(O)=O)=C1 VJVSNPXBBRHNRF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- NJKLZQRABVFDJP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-(hydrazinecarbonyl)-N-methylbenzenesulfonamide Chemical compound CNS(=O)(=O)C1=CC=CC(C(=O)NN)=C1 NJKLZQRABVFDJP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- PFEOZHBOMNWTJB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-Methylpentane Chemical compound CCC(C)CC PFEOZHBOMNWTJB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- LMRKXSDOAFUINK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-chlorosulfonylbenzoic acid Chemical compound OC(=O)C1=CC=CC(S(Cl)(=O)=O)=C1 LMRKXSDOAFUINK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- JHVLVYXHBGGAFG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-pyrrolidin-1-ylsulfonylbenzohydrazide Chemical compound NNC(=O)C1=CC=CC(S(=O)(=O)N2CCCC2)=C1 JHVLVYXHBGGAFG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- KFEAEBVYSWALAN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4-morpholin-4-ylsulfonylbenzohydrazide Chemical compound C1=CC(C(=O)NN)=CC=C1S(=O)(=O)N1CCOCC1 KFEAEBVYSWALAN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 101700033661 ACTB Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 102100011550 ACTB Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 101710032514 ACTI Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 206010003571 Astrocytoma Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 206010065869 Astrocytoma, low grade Diseases 0.000 description 3
- IXIBAKNTJSCKJM-BUBXBXGNSA-N Bovine insulin Chemical compound C([C@@H](C(=O)N[C@@H](CC(C)C)C(=O)N[C@H]1CSSC[C@H]2C(=O)N[C@@H](C)C(=O)N[C@@H](CO)C(=O)N[C@H](C(=O)N[C@H](C(N[C@@H](CO)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC(C)C)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC=3C=CC(O)=CC=3)C(=O)N[C@@H](CCC(N)=O)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC(C)C)C(=O)N[C@@H](CCC(O)=O)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC(N)=O)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC=3C=CC(O)=CC=3)C(=O)N[C@@H](CSSC[C@H](NC(=O)[C@H](C(C)C)NC(=O)[C@H](CC(C)C)NC(=O)[C@H](CC=3C=CC(O)=CC=3)NC(=O)[C@H](CC(C)C)NC(=O)[C@H](C)NC(=O)[C@H](CCC(O)=O)NC(=O)[C@H](C(C)C)NC(=O)[C@H](CC(C)C)NC(=O)[C@H](CC=3NC=NC=3)NC(=O)[C@H](CO)NC(=O)CNC1=O)C(=O)NCC(=O)N[C@@H](CCC(O)=O)C(=O)N[C@@H](CCCNC(N)=N)C(=O)NCC(=O)N[C@@H](CC=1C=CC=CC=1)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC=1C=CC=CC=1)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC=1C=CC(O)=CC=1)C(=O)N[C@@H]([C@@H](C)O)C(=O)N1[C@@H](CCC1)C(=O)N[C@@H](CCCCN)C(=O)N[C@@H](C)C(O)=O)C(=O)N[C@@H](CC(N)=O)C(O)=O)=O)CSSC[C@@H](C(N2)=O)NC(=O)[C@H](CCC(N)=O)NC(=O)[C@H](CCC(O)=O)NC(=O)[C@H](C(C)C)NC(=O)[C@@H](NC(=O)CN)[C@@H](C)CC)C(C)C)NC(=O)[C@H](CCC(N)=O)NC(=O)[C@H](CC(N)=O)NC(=O)[C@@H](NC(=O)[C@@H](N)CC=1C=CC=CC=1)C(C)C)C1=CN=CN1 IXIBAKNTJSCKJM-BUBXBXGNSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 101700021120 CTBP1 Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 102100008586 CTBP1 Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 206010009944 Colon cancer Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 230000036826 Excretion Effects 0.000 description 3
- 101700021312 H2BS1 Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 102100002658 H2BS1 Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 102100002572 HDAC1 Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 101700036927 HDAC1 Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 101710045213 HMG20B Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 102100020390 HMG20B Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 108010033040 Histones Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 102000006947 Histones Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 101700065946 LYS4 Proteins 0.000 description 3
- HAUVWRQIVOPGOE-FOWTUZBSSA-N N-[(E)-1-phenylethylideneamino]benzamide Chemical class C=1C=CC=CC=1C(/C)=N/NC(=O)C1=CC=CC=C1 HAUVWRQIVOPGOE-FOWTUZBSSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 102000007399 Nuclear hormone receptors Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 108020005497 Nuclear hormone receptors Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 206010033128 Ovarian cancer Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 108020005203 Oxidases Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 101710005282 PHF21A Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 102100018922 PHF21A Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 208000008443 Pancreatic Carcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 229920002685 Polyoxyl 35CastorOil Polymers 0.000 description 3
- 239000004721 Polyphenylene oxide Substances 0.000 description 3
- 208000003991 Primitive Neuroectodermal Tumors Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 206010057846 Primitive neuroectodermal tumour Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 206010057644 Testis cancer Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 238000010521 absorption reaction Methods 0.000 description 3
- 238000006640 acetylation reaction Methods 0.000 description 3
- 125000002947 alkylene group Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- 229920002892 amber Polymers 0.000 description 3
- 125000002619 bicyclic group Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- 239000011230 binding agent Substances 0.000 description 3
- GDTBXPJZTBHREO-UHFFFAOYSA-N bromine Substances BrBr GDTBXPJZTBHREO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- WKBOTKDWSSQWDR-UHFFFAOYSA-N bromine atom Chemical compound [Br] WKBOTKDWSSQWDR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 238000004113 cell culture Methods 0.000 description 3
- 238000002648 combination therapy Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000000875 corresponding Effects 0.000 description 3
- 239000006071 cream Substances 0.000 description 3
- XDTMQSROBMDMFD-UHFFFAOYSA-N cyclohexane Chemical compound C1CCCCC1 XDTMQSROBMDMFD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 238000001514 detection method Methods 0.000 description 3
- 238000011161 development Methods 0.000 description 3
- 230000018109 developmental process Effects 0.000 description 3
- 238000003745 diagnosis Methods 0.000 description 3
- 235000005911 diet Nutrition 0.000 description 3
- 230000037213 diet Effects 0.000 description 3
- 239000000839 emulsion Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000001973 epigenetic Effects 0.000 description 3
- 239000000262 estrogen Substances 0.000 description 3
- 125000000219 ethylidene group Chemical group [H]C(=[*])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 3
- 230000029142 excretion Effects 0.000 description 3
- 230000002349 favourable Effects 0.000 description 3
- 125000004072 flavinyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- 201000010915 glioblastoma multiforme Diseases 0.000 description 3
- LYCAIKOWRPUZTN-UHFFFAOYSA-N glycol Chemical group OCCO LYCAIKOWRPUZTN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 239000008187 granular material Substances 0.000 description 3
- 239000001963 growth media Substances 0.000 description 3
- 230000036541 health Effects 0.000 description 3
- 150000002430 hydrocarbons Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- 239000007972 injectable composition Substances 0.000 description 3
- 238000007918 intramuscular administration Methods 0.000 description 3
- 239000011630 iodine Substances 0.000 description 3
- PNDPGZBMCMUPRI-UHFFFAOYSA-N iodine Chemical compound II PNDPGZBMCMUPRI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 201000007270 liver cancer Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 239000000314 lubricant Substances 0.000 description 3
- 101700072735 lys-1 Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 239000002184 metal Substances 0.000 description 3
- CJSAGXXCWIJTDO-UHFFFAOYSA-N methyl 3-(1,1-dioxo-1,4-thiazinan-4-yl)benzoate Chemical compound COC(=O)C1=CC=CC(N2CCS(=O)(=O)CC2)=C1 CJSAGXXCWIJTDO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- ZOSYKCWTRNDOLF-UHFFFAOYSA-N methyl 3-(4-methylpiperidin-1-yl)sulfonylbenzoate Chemical compound COC(=O)C1=CC=CC(S(=O)(=O)N2CCC(C)CC2)=C1 ZOSYKCWTRNDOLF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- YWGWNNZDUMTNNS-UHFFFAOYSA-N methyl 3-(methylsulfamoyl)benzoate Chemical compound CNS(=O)(=O)C1=CC=CC(C(=O)OC)=C1 YWGWNNZDUMTNNS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- KKQRDIWDACTPSP-UHFFFAOYSA-N methyl 3-pyrrolidin-1-ylsulfonylbenzoate Chemical compound COC(=O)C1=CC=CC(S(=O)(=O)N2CCCC2)=C1 KKQRDIWDACTPSP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- BUYUOBGADRKVAP-UHFFFAOYSA-N methyl 3-sulfamoylbenzoate Chemical compound COC(=O)C1=CC=CC(S(N)(=O)=O)=C1 BUYUOBGADRKVAP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- AENFSNKXDAZGCB-UHFFFAOYSA-N methyl 4-morpholin-4-ylsulfonylbenzoate Chemical compound C1=CC(C(=O)OC)=CC=C1S(=O)(=O)N1CCOCC1 AENFSNKXDAZGCB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 244000005700 microbiome Species 0.000 description 3
- 239000006956 minimum essential medium Substances 0.000 description 3
- 238000000329 molecular dynamics simulation Methods 0.000 description 3
- 238000000465 moulding Methods 0.000 description 3
- 201000000050 myeloid neoplasm Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 125000001280 n-hexyl group Chemical group C(CCCCC)* 0.000 description 3
- 239000003921 oil Substances 0.000 description 3
- 210000000056 organs Anatomy 0.000 description 3
- 201000002528 pancreatic cancer Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 239000002245 particle Substances 0.000 description 3
- 239000008188 pellet Substances 0.000 description 3
- ISWSIDIOOBJBQZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N phenol Chemical compound OC1=CC=CC=C1 ISWSIDIOOBJBQZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 229920000768 polyamine Polymers 0.000 description 3
- 229920000570 polyether Polymers 0.000 description 3
- 239000008389 polyethoxylated castor oil Substances 0.000 description 3
- 229920001223 polyethylene glycol Polymers 0.000 description 3
- 229920000642 polymer Polymers 0.000 description 3
- 239000000651 prodrug Substances 0.000 description 3
- 229940002612 prodrugs Drugs 0.000 description 3
- 238000000746 purification Methods 0.000 description 3
- 150000003222 pyridines Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 238000003753 real-time PCR Methods 0.000 description 3
- 102000005962 receptors Human genes 0.000 description 3
- 108020003175 receptors Proteins 0.000 description 3
- 238000011084 recovery Methods 0.000 description 3
- CXMXRPHRNRROMY-UHFFFAOYSA-N sebacic acid group Chemical group C(CCCCCCCCC(=O)O)(=O)O CXMXRPHRNRROMY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 239000000741 silica gel Substances 0.000 description 3
- 229910002027 silica gel Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- HEMHJVSKTPXQMS-UHFFFAOYSA-M sodium hydroxide Chemical compound [OH-].[Na+] HEMHJVSKTPXQMS-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 3
- 239000008107 starch Substances 0.000 description 3
- 238000003756 stirring Methods 0.000 description 3
- 238000007920 subcutaneous administration Methods 0.000 description 3
- 125000005346 substituted cycloalkyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- 235000000346 sugar Nutrition 0.000 description 3
- 150000008163 sugars Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 150000003457 sulfones Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 239000000829 suppository Substances 0.000 description 3
- 238000003786 synthesis reaction Methods 0.000 description 3
- 125000001973 tert-pentyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C(*)(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 3
- 201000003120 testicular cancer Diseases 0.000 description 3
- 230000001988 toxicity Effects 0.000 description 3
- 231100000419 toxicity Toxicity 0.000 description 3
- 239000003981 vehicle Substances 0.000 description 3
- UGUHFDPGDQDVGX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,2,3-thiadiazole Chemical compound C1=CSN=N1 UGUHFDPGDQDVGX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- PKYCWFICOKSIHZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-(3,7-dihydroxyphenoxazin-10-yl)ethanone Chemical compound OC1=CC=C2N(C(=O)C)C3=CC=C(O)C=C3OC2=C1 PKYCWFICOKSIHZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- PVOAHINGSUIXLS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-methylpiperazine Chemical compound CN1CCNCC1 PVOAHINGSUIXLS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- KJUGUADJHNHALS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1H-tetrazole Chemical compound C=1N=NNN=1 KJUGUADJHNHALS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- LENZDBCJOHFCAS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-amino-2-(hydroxymethyl)propane-1,3-diol Chemical compound OCC(N)(CO)CO LENZDBCJOHFCAS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- AEELHPSJKHUGEA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-methylbut-1-ene Chemical group [CH2+]C(=C)C[CH2-] AEELHPSJKHUGEA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- HKZCTGLTIWIBCC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-morpholin-4-ylsulfonylbenzohydrazide Chemical compound NNC(=O)C1=CC=CC=C1S(=O)(=O)N1CCOCC1 HKZCTGLTIWIBCC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- NFCPTRUYPLTQEW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-(1,1-dioxo-1,4-thiazinan-4-yl)benzohydrazide Chemical compound NNC(=O)C1=CC=CC(N2CCS(=O)(=O)CC2)=C1 NFCPTRUYPLTQEW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- HLMDMSZONMGJRP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-(4-methylpiperidin-1-yl)sulfonylbenzohydrazide Chemical compound C1CC(C)CCN1S(=O)(=O)C1=CC=CC(C(=O)NN)=C1 HLMDMSZONMGJRP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- PFADICZLFNMCQX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-(4-methylpiperidin-1-yl)sulfonylbenzoic acid Chemical compound C1CC(C)CCN1S(=O)(=O)C1=CC=CC(C(O)=O)=C1 PFADICZLFNMCQX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- PDYSBCAKDARVOS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-(hydrazinecarbonyl)-N,N-dimethylbenzenesulfonamide Chemical compound CN(C)S(=O)(=O)C1=CC=CC(C(=O)NN)=C1 PDYSBCAKDARVOS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- LQOXNXRLHXIPRE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-(hydrazinecarbonyl)benzenesulfonamide Chemical compound NNC(=O)C1=CC=CC(S(N)(=O)=O)=C1 LQOXNXRLHXIPRE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- QPQVGKOKFZZZMQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-methylsulfonylbenzohydrazide Chemical compound CS(=O)(=O)C1=CC=CC(C(=O)NN)=C1 QPQVGKOKFZZZMQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- WLNYFSLDILSTCK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-morpholin-4-ylbenzohydrazide Chemical compound NNC(=O)C1=CC=CC(N2CCOCC2)=C1 WLNYFSLDILSTCK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- LYGWBPDKDLWHHB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-morpholin-4-ylsulfonylbenzoic acid Chemical compound OC(=O)C1=CC=CC(S(=O)(=O)N2CCOCC2)=C1 LYGWBPDKDLWHHB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- XMPZDEDUKZSOHQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-piperidin-1-ylsulfonylbenzohydrazide Chemical compound NNC(=O)C1=CC=CC(S(=O)(=O)N2CCCCC2)=C1 XMPZDEDUKZSOHQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- UZOFELREXGAFOI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4-methylpiperidine Chemical compound CC1CCNCC1 UZOFELREXGAFOI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- ZMVCEJXFZSJPDZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 5-methylsulfonylpyridine-3-carbohydrazide Chemical compound CS(=O)(=O)C1=CN=CC(C(=O)NN)=C1 ZMVCEJXFZSJPDZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 206010000880 Acute myeloid leukaemia Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 239000004475 Arginine Substances 0.000 description 2
- 241000283690 Bos taurus Species 0.000 description 2
- 241000282472 Canis lupus familiaris Species 0.000 description 2
- 241000283707 Capra Species 0.000 description 2
- 229920002134 Carboxymethyl cellulose Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 241000700199 Cavia porcellus Species 0.000 description 2
- 210000003483 Chromatin Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 108010077544 Chromatin Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 102000020504 Collagenase family Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 108060005980 Collagenase family Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 208000009798 Craniopharyngioma Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 241000699662 Cricetomys gambianus Species 0.000 description 2
- DMEGYFMYUHOHGS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Cycloheptane Chemical compound C1CCCCCC1 DMEGYFMYUHOHGS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- WJTCGQSWYFHTAC-UHFFFAOYSA-N Cyclooctane Chemical compound C1CCCCCCC1 WJTCGQSWYFHTAC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- CZMRCDWAGMRECN-UGDNZRGBSA-N D-sucrose Chemical compound O[C@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O[C@@]1(CO)O[C@@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O1 CZMRCDWAGMRECN-UGDNZRGBSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 230000007067 DNA methylation Effects 0.000 description 2
- DIOQZVSQGTUSAI-UHFFFAOYSA-N Decane Chemical compound CCCCCCCCCC DIOQZVSQGTUSAI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- SNRUBQQJIBEYMU-UHFFFAOYSA-N Dodecane Chemical compound CCCCCCCCCCCC SNRUBQQJIBEYMU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 208000006402 Ductal Carcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 102000018251 EC 2.4.2.8 Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 108010091358 EC 2.4.2.8 Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 206010014733 Endometrial cancer Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 206010014967 Ependymoma Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 102000033923 FAD binding proteins Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 108091000328 FAD binding proteins Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 206010017758 Gastric cancer Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 108010010803 Gelatin Proteins 0.000 description 2
- JKMHFZQWWAIEOD-UHFFFAOYSA-N HEPES Chemical compound OCC[NH+]1CCN(CCS([O-])(=O)=O)CC1 JKMHFZQWWAIEOD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 239000007995 HEPES buffer Substances 0.000 description 2
- WZUVPPKBWHMQCE-VYIIXAMBSA-N Haematoxylin Chemical compound C12=CC(O)=C(O)C=C2C[C@@]2(O)C1C1=CC=C(O)C(O)=C1OC2 WZUVPPKBWHMQCE-VYIIXAMBSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 230000036499 Half live Effects 0.000 description 2
- 210000003128 Head Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 206010020243 Hodgkin's disease Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 201000006743 Hodgkin's lymphoma Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 108010001336 Horseradish Peroxidase Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 201000001971 Huntington's disease Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 229920002153 Hydroxypropyl cellulose Polymers 0.000 description 2
- RAXXELZNTBOGNW-UHFFFAOYSA-N Imidazole Chemical compound C1=CNC=N1 RAXXELZNTBOGNW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- ODKSFYDXXFIFQN-BYPYZUCNSA-P L-argininium(2+) Chemical compound NC(=[NH2+])NCCC[C@H]([NH3+])C(O)=O ODKSFYDXXFIFQN-BYPYZUCNSA-P 0.000 description 2
- 208000008456 Leukemia, Myelogenous, Chronic, BCR-ABL Positive Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 208000007046 Leukemia, Myeloid, Acute Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 208000000214 Leukemia, Myelomonocytic, Chronic Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 208000002490 Leukemia, Myelomonocytic, Juvenile Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 206010058467 Lung neoplasm malignant Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 102100001422 MAOA Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 101710004794 MAOA Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 101710040126 MAOB Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 102100001420 MAOB Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 206010025650 Malignant melanoma Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 208000000172 Medulloblastoma Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 206010029260 Neuroblastoma Diseases 0.000 description 2
- BKIMMITUMNQMOS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Nonane Chemical compound CCCCCCCCC BKIMMITUMNQMOS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- SBOJXQVPLKSXOG-UHFFFAOYSA-N O-amino-Hydroxylamine Chemical compound NON SBOJXQVPLKSXOG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- TVMXDCGIABBOFY-UHFFFAOYSA-N Octane Chemical compound CCCCCCCC TVMXDCGIABBOFY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 206010073131 Oligoastrocytoma Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 210000003463 Organelles Anatomy 0.000 description 2
- 241000283973 Oryctolagus cuniculus Species 0.000 description 2
- 241000283898 Ovis Species 0.000 description 2
- XAPRFLSJBSXESP-UHFFFAOYSA-N Oxycinchophen Chemical compound N=1C2=CC=CC=C2C(C(=O)O)=C(O)C=1C1=CC=CC=C1 XAPRFLSJBSXESP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 206010061536 Parkinson's disease Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 229940049954 Penicillin Drugs 0.000 description 2
- JGSARLDLIJGVTE-MBNYWOFBSA-N Penicillin G Chemical compound N([C@H]1[C@H]2SC([C@@H](N2C1=O)C(O)=O)(C)C)C(=O)CC1=CC=CC=C1 JGSARLDLIJGVTE-MBNYWOFBSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 239000002202 Polyethylene glycol Substances 0.000 description 2
- 208000006664 Precursor Cell Lymphoblastic Leukemia-Lymphoma Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 108010081734 Ribonucleoproteins Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 102000004389 Ribonucleoproteins Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 102100019388 SOAT1 Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 101700025022 SOAT1 Proteins 0.000 description 2
- QIQXTHQIDYTFRH-UHFFFAOYSA-N Stearic acid Chemical compound CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC(O)=O QIQXTHQIDYTFRH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229960005322 Streptomycin Drugs 0.000 description 2
- CZMRCDWAGMRECN-GDQSFJPYSA-N Sucrose Natural products O([C@@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@H](CO)O1)[C@@]1(CO)[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O1 CZMRCDWAGMRECN-GDQSFJPYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- YAPQBXQYLJRXSA-UHFFFAOYSA-N Theobromine Chemical compound CN1C(=O)NC(=O)C2=C1N=CN2C YAPQBXQYLJRXSA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- KWIUHFFTVRNATP-UHFFFAOYSA-N Trimethylglycine Chemical compound C[N+](C)(C)CC([O-])=O KWIUHFFTVRNATP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- RSJKGSCJYJTIGS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Undecane Chemical compound CCCCCCCCCCC RSJKGSCJYJTIGS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- NBIIXXVUZAFLBC-UHFFFAOYSA-K [O-]P([O-])([O-])=O Chemical compound [O-]P([O-])([O-])=O NBIIXXVUZAFLBC-UHFFFAOYSA-K 0.000 description 2
- JEPQPEXKXMKRGQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N [O].C1COCCN1 Chemical compound [O].C1COCCN1 JEPQPEXKXMKRGQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 230000002378 acidificating Effects 0.000 description 2
- 150000007513 acids Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 201000005510 acute lymphocytic leukemia Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 125000002015 acyclic group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- 230000002730 additional Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000001476 alcoholic Effects 0.000 description 2
- 125000005431 alkyl carboxamide group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- 229910052782 aluminium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 125000000539 amino acid group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- 239000003708 ampul Substances 0.000 description 2
- 125000000129 anionic group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- 230000003466 anti-cipated Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000000259 anti-tumor Effects 0.000 description 2
- 229960003121 arginine Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 238000003149 assay kit Methods 0.000 description 2
- UHOVQNZJYSORNB-UHFFFAOYSA-N benzene Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1 UHOVQNZJYSORNB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 125000001797 benzyl group Chemical group [H]C1=C([H])C([H])=C(C([H])=C1[H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 2
- 125000001584 benzyloxycarbonyl group Chemical group C(=O)(OCC1=CC=CC=C1)* 0.000 description 2
- 229960000626 benzylpenicillin Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 230000031018 biological processes and functions Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000004305 biphenyl Substances 0.000 description 2
- 235000010290 biphenyl Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- UIIMBOGNXHQVGW-UHFFFAOYSA-M buffer Substances [Na+].OC([O-])=O UIIMBOGNXHQVGW-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 2
- RYYVLZVUVIJVGH-UHFFFAOYSA-N caffeine Chemical compound CN1C(=O)N(C)C(=O)C2=C1N=CN2C RYYVLZVUVIJVGH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 239000011575 calcium Substances 0.000 description 2
- 235000010948 carboxy methyl cellulose Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 239000001768 carboxy methyl cellulose Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000008112 carboxymethyl-cellulose Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000003197 catalytic Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000012292 cell migration Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000003833 cell viability Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000003570 cell viability assay Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000002512 chemotherapy Methods 0.000 description 2
- 201000006934 chronic myeloid leukemia Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 201000010902 chronic myelomonocytic leukemia Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 229960002424 collagenase Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 201000011231 colorectal cancer Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 230000037011 constitutive activity Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000001276 controlling effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000002596 correlated Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000001808 coupling Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000010168 coupling process Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000005859 coupling reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 125000004122 cyclic group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- 239000004914 cyclooctane Substances 0.000 description 2
- 125000005432 dialkylcarboxamide group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- ZUOUZKKEUPVFJK-UHFFFAOYSA-N diphenyl Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC=CC=C1 ZUOUZKKEUPVFJK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 125000005982 diphenylmethyl group Chemical group [H]C1=C([H])C([H])=C(C([H])=C1[H])C([H])(*)C1=C([H])C([H])=C([H])C([H])=C1[H] 0.000 description 2
- 239000002270 dispersing agent Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000000890 drug combination Substances 0.000 description 2
- 125000006575 electron-withdrawing group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- 238000010828 elution Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000005886 esterification reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000005284 excitation Effects 0.000 description 2
- 102000028589 flavin monoamine oxidase family Human genes 0.000 description 2
- 108091014578 flavin monoamine oxidase family Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 239000000796 flavoring agent Substances 0.000 description 2
- 235000013355 food flavoring agent Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 125000002485 formyl group Chemical group [H]C(*)=O 0.000 description 2
- 201000004066 ganglioglioma Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 239000008273 gelatin Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229920000159 gelatin Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 239000007903 gelatin capsule Substances 0.000 description 2
- 235000019322 gelatine Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 235000011852 gelatine desserts Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 230000002489 hematologic Effects 0.000 description 2
- 125000004366 heterocycloalkenyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- 238000005984 hydrogenation reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 235000010977 hydroxypropyl cellulose Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 239000001863 hydroxypropyl cellulose Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229940071676 hydroxypropylcellulose Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 238000002991 immunohistochemical analysis Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000001976 improved Effects 0.000 description 2
- 150000007529 inorganic bases Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- NOESYZHRGYRDHS-UHFFFAOYSA-N insulin Chemical compound N1C(=O)C(NC(=O)C(CCC(N)=O)NC(=O)C(CCC(O)=O)NC(=O)C(C(C)C)NC(=O)C(NC(=O)CN)C(C)CC)CSSCC(C(NC(CO)C(=O)NC(CC(C)C)C(=O)NC(CC=2C=CC(O)=CC=2)C(=O)NC(CCC(N)=O)C(=O)NC(CC(C)C)C(=O)NC(CCC(O)=O)C(=O)NC(CC(N)=O)C(=O)NC(CC=2C=CC(O)=CC=2)C(=O)NC(CSSCC(NC(=O)C(C(C)C)NC(=O)C(CC(C)C)NC(=O)C(CC=2C=CC(O)=CC=2)NC(=O)C(CC(C)C)NC(=O)C(C)NC(=O)C(CCC(O)=O)NC(=O)C(C(C)C)NC(=O)C(CC(C)C)NC(=O)C(CC=2NC=NC=2)NC(=O)C(CO)NC(=O)CNC2=O)C(=O)NCC(=O)NC(CCC(O)=O)C(=O)NC(CCCNC(N)=N)C(=O)NCC(=O)NC(CC=3C=CC=CC=3)C(=O)NC(CC=3C=CC=CC=3)C(=O)NC(CC=3C=CC(O)=CC=3)C(=O)NC(C(C)O)C(=O)N3C(CCC3)C(=O)NC(CCCCN)C(=O)NC(C)C(O)=O)C(=O)NC(CC(N)=O)C(O)=O)=O)NC(=O)C(C(C)CC)NC(=O)C(CO)NC(=O)C(C(C)O)NC(=O)C1CSSCC2NC(=O)C(CC(C)C)NC(=O)C(NC(=O)C(CCC(N)=O)NC(=O)C(CC(N)=O)NC(=O)C(NC(=O)C(N)CC=1C=CC=CC=1)C(C)C)CC1=CN=CN1 NOESYZHRGYRDHS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 238000010253 intravenous injection Methods 0.000 description 2
- 201000005992 juvenile myelomonocytic leukemia Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 101700056991 lsd2 Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 238000007422 luminescence assay Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000004020 luminiscence type Methods 0.000 description 2
- 201000005202 lung cancer Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 201000001441 melanoma Diseases 0.000 description 2
- TZKDPBATMOYEBO-UHFFFAOYSA-N methyl 3-(dimethylsulfamoyl)benzoate Chemical compound COC(=O)C1=CC=CC(S(=O)(=O)N(C)C)=C1 TZKDPBATMOYEBO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- OWPJVOSLLKRKQJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N methyl 3-bromo-2-chlorobenzoate Chemical compound COC(=O)C1=CC=CC(Br)=C1Cl OWPJVOSLLKRKQJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- IRGQOQZEMROKPB-UHFFFAOYSA-N methyl 3-morpholin-4-ylsulfonylbenzoate Chemical compound COC(=O)C1=CC=CC(S(=O)(=O)N2CCOCC2)=C1 IRGQOQZEMROKPB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- TVUWLLCWQGXPSH-UHFFFAOYSA-N methyl 5-chloropyridine-3-carboxylate Chemical compound COC(=O)C1=CN=CC(Cl)=C1 TVUWLLCWQGXPSH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 125000004092 methylthiomethyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])SC([H])([H])* 0.000 description 2
- 125000002950 monocyclic group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- IMNFDUFMRHMDMM-UHFFFAOYSA-N n-heptane Chemical compound CCCCCCC IMNFDUFMRHMDMM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 230000017095 negative regulation of cell growth Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000001264 neutralization Effects 0.000 description 2
- 235000019198 oils Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 201000010133 oligodendroglioma Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 239000004006 olive oil Substances 0.000 description 2
- 235000008390 olive oil Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 238000005457 optimization Methods 0.000 description 2
- ZCQWOFVYLHDMMC-UHFFFAOYSA-N oxazole Chemical compound C1=COC=N1 ZCQWOFVYLHDMMC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 230000017693 oxidative demethylation Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000007067 oxidative demethylation reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000012188 paraffin wax Substances 0.000 description 2
- 238000007911 parenteral administration Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000000737 periodic Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000002085 persistent Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000000825 pharmaceutical preparation Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000000275 pharmacokinetic Effects 0.000 description 2
- 239000010452 phosphate Substances 0.000 description 2
- GLUUGHFHXGJENI-UHFFFAOYSA-N piperazine Chemical compound C1CNCCN1 GLUUGHFHXGJENI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- NQRYJNQNLNOLGT-UHFFFAOYSA-N piperidine Chemical compound C1CCNCC1 NQRYJNQNLNOLGT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229920001281 polyalkylene Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 229920005862 polyol Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 150000003077 polyols Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 229920000036 polyvinylpyrrolidone Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 239000011148 porous material Substances 0.000 description 2
- 230000001681 protective Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000005588 protonation Effects 0.000 description 2
- RWRDLPDLKQPQOW-UHFFFAOYSA-N pyrrolidine Chemical compound C1CCNC1 RWRDLPDLKQPQOW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 230000002829 reduced Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000022983 regulation of cell cycle Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000001718 repressive Effects 0.000 description 2
- HSSLDCABUXLXKM-UHFFFAOYSA-N resorufin Chemical compound C1=CC(=O)C=C2OC3=CC(O)=CC=C3N=C21 HSSLDCABUXLXKM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 101710028406 satA Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 238000007423 screening assay Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000035945 sensitivity Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000000926 separation method Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000001187 sodium carbonate Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229910000029 sodium carbonate Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 238000010186 staining Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000007858 starting material Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000008223 sterile water Substances 0.000 description 2
- 201000011549 stomach cancer Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 201000004059 subependymal giant cell astrocytoma Diseases 0.000 description 2
- 239000005720 sucrose Substances 0.000 description 2
- QAOWNCQODCNURD-UHFFFAOYSA-L sulfate Chemical compound [O-]S([O-])(=O)=O QAOWNCQODCNURD-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 2
- 125000000472 sulfonyl group Chemical group *S(*)(=O)=O 0.000 description 2
- 239000000454 talc Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229910052623 talc Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 235000012222 talc Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- ILMRJRBKQSSXGY-UHFFFAOYSA-N tert-butyl(dimethyl)silicon Chemical compound C[Si](C)C(C)(C)C ILMRJRBKQSSXGY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 125000001981 tert-butyldimethylsilyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])[Si]([H])(C([H])([H])[H])[*]C(C([H])([H])[H])(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 2
- 125000005931 tert-butyloxycarbonyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C(OC(*)=O)(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 2
- 230000004797 therapeutic response Effects 0.000 description 2
- 230000002110 toxicologic Effects 0.000 description 2
- 231100000027 toxicology Toxicity 0.000 description 2
- 230000001131 transforming Effects 0.000 description 2
- ZMANZCXQSJIPKH-UHFFFAOYSA-N triethylamine Chemical compound CCN(CC)CC ZMANZCXQSJIPKH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- QXTIBZLKQPJVII-UHFFFAOYSA-N triethylsilicon Chemical group CC[Si](CC)CC QXTIBZLKQPJVII-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 235000015112 vegetable and seed oil Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 239000008158 vegetable oil Substances 0.000 description 2
- 238000011179 visual inspection Methods 0.000 description 2
- HCHKCACWOHOZIP-UHFFFAOYSA-N zinc Chemical compound [Zn] HCHKCACWOHOZIP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229910052725 zinc Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 239000011701 zinc Substances 0.000 description 2
- JOGKWALAFPNFPR-VURMDHGXSA-N (4Z)-cycloocta-1,4-diene Chemical group [CH]1CC\C=C/CC=C1 JOGKWALAFPNFPR-VURMDHGXSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000003088 (fluoren-9-ylmethoxy)carbonyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- QWENRTYMTSOGBR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,2,3-triazole Chemical compound C=1C=NNN=1 QWENRTYMTSOGBR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- HTJMXYRLEDBSLT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,2,4,5-tetrazine Chemical compound C1=NN=CN=N1 HTJMXYRLEDBSLT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- FYADHXFMURLYQI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,2,4-triazine Chemical compound C1=CN=NC=N1 FYADHXFMURLYQI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- UDGKZGLPXCRRAM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,2,5-thiadiazole Chemical compound C=1C=NSN=1 UDGKZGLPXCRRAM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- PIICEJLVQHRZGT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,2-ethanediamine Chemical compound NCCN PIICEJLVQHRZGT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- FKASFBLJDCHBNZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,3,4-oxadiazole Chemical compound C1=NN=CO1 FKASFBLJDCHBNZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- MBIZXFATKUQOOA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,3,4-thiadiazole Chemical compound C1=NN=CS1 MBIZXFATKUQOOA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- JIHQDMXYYFUGFV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,3,5-Triazine Chemical compound C1=NC=NC=N1 JIHQDMXYYFUGFV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ZOBPZXTWZATXDG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,3-thiazolidine-2,4-dione Chemical compound O=C1CSC(=O)N1 ZOBPZXTWZATXDG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- COVZYZSDYWQREU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,4-Butanediol, dimethanesulfonate Chemical compound CS(=O)(=O)OCCCCOS(C)(=O)=O COVZYZSDYWQREU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- RYHBNJHYFVUHQT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,4-dioxane Chemical compound C1COCCO1 RYHBNJHYFVUHQT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- CYNFEPKQDJHIMV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-(2,5-dichlorophenyl)ethanone Chemical compound CC(=O)C1=CC(Cl)=CC=C1Cl CYNFEPKQDJHIMV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- WIWIOUAFBHZLNQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-(2-chloropyridin-3-yl)ethanone Chemical compound CC(=O)C1=CC=CN=C1Cl WIWIOUAFBHZLNQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ZHDLNEIXOUIAQO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-(3-chloro-2-fluorophenyl)ethanone Chemical compound CC(=O)C1=CC=CC(Cl)=C1F ZHDLNEIXOUIAQO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- GCAFAZLJICOINM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-(5-chloro-2-fluorophenyl)ethanone Chemical compound CC(=O)C1=CC(Cl)=CC=C1F GCAFAZLJICOINM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- HVXQVXNQKCPSLH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-(5-chloro-2-nitrophenyl)ethanone Chemical compound CC(=O)C1=CC(Cl)=CC=C1[N+]([O-])=O HVXQVXNQKCPSLH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- JLPULHDHAOZNQI-ZTIMHPMXSA-N 1-hexadecanoyl-2-(9Z,12Z-octadecadienoyl)-sn-glycero-3-phosphocholine Chemical compound CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC(=O)OC[C@H](COP([O-])(=O)OCC[N+](C)(C)C)OC(=O)CCCCCCC\C=C/C\C=C/CCCCC JLPULHDHAOZNQI-ZTIMHPMXSA-N 0.000 description 1
- NSPMIYGKQJPBQR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1H-1,2,4-triazole Chemical compound C=1N=CNN=1 NSPMIYGKQJPBQR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- YPTJKHVBDCRKNF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2',6'-Dihydroxyacetophenone Chemical compound CC(=O)C1=C(O)C=CC=C1O YPTJKHVBDCRKNF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- VUKAUDKDFVSVFT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-[6-[4,5-bis(2-hydroxypropoxy)-2-(2-hydroxypropoxymethyl)-6-methoxyoxan-3-yl]oxy-4,5-dimethoxy-2-(methoxymethyl)oxan-3-yl]oxy-6-(hydroxymethyl)-5-methoxyoxane-3,4-diol Chemical compound COC1C(OC)C(OC2C(C(O)C(OC)C(CO)O2)O)C(COC)OC1OC1C(COCC(C)O)OC(OC)C(OCC(C)O)C1OCC(C)O VUKAUDKDFVSVFT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- MSWZFWKMSRAUBD-IVMDWMLBSA-N 2-amino-2-deoxy-D-glucopyranose Chemical compound N[C@H]1C(O)O[C@H](CO)[C@@H](O)[C@@H]1O MSWZFWKMSRAUBD-IVMDWMLBSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229940013085 2-diethylaminoethanol Drugs 0.000 description 1
- YTQKWJNSSYODEV-UHFFFAOYSA-M 2-morpholin-4-ylsulfonylbenzoate Chemical compound [O-]C(=O)C1=CC=CC=C1S(=O)(=O)N1CCOCC1 YTQKWJNSSYODEV-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 1
- CZPWVGJYEJSRLH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 289-95-2 Chemical compound C1=CN=CN=C1 CZPWVGJYEJSRLH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- QHYKHHRRGZXUKP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-(1,1-dioxo-1,4-thiazinan-4-yl)benzoic acid Chemical compound OC(=O)C1=CC=CC(N2CCS(=O)(=O)CC2)=C1 QHYKHHRRGZXUKP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ZYUAOEFMKIYOPZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-(dimethylsulfamoyl)benzoic acid Chemical compound CN(C)S(=O)(=O)C1=CC=CC(C(O)=O)=C1 ZYUAOEFMKIYOPZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- UTZKLODUDPSLBT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-(methylsulfamoyl)benzoic acid Chemical compound CNS(=O)(=O)C1=CC=CC(C(O)=O)=C1 UTZKLODUDPSLBT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- MTUNUUCPISDYNN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-bromo-2-chlorobenzohydrazide Chemical compound NNC(=O)C1=CC=CC(Br)=C1Cl MTUNUUCPISDYNN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- LNURMIDMOXCNEH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-bromo-2-chlorobenzoic acid Chemical compound OC(=O)C1=CC=CC(Br)=C1Cl LNURMIDMOXCNEH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- UZMCSTKSVWZMJA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-pyrrolidin-1-ylsulfonylbenzoic acid Chemical compound OC(=O)C1=CC=CC(S(=O)(=O)N2CCCC2)=C1 UZMCSTKSVWZMJA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- NAETXYOXMDYNLE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-sulfamoylbenzoic acid Chemical compound NS(=O)(=O)C1=CC=CC(C(O)=O)=C1 NAETXYOXMDYNLE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000006281 4-bromobenzyl group Chemical group [H]C1=C([H])C(=C([H])C([H])=C1Br)C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 1
- 125000006283 4-chlorobenzyl group Chemical group [H]C1=C([H])C(=C([H])C([H])=C1Cl)C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 1
- HVCNXQOWACZAFN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4-ethylmorpholine Chemical compound CCN1CCOCC1 HVCNXQOWACZAFN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000004176 4-fluorobenzyl group Chemical group [H]C1=C([H])C(=C([H])C([H])=C1F)C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 1
- IGXVSENNUSQCOL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4-morpholin-4-ylsulfonylbenzoic acid Chemical compound C1=CC(C(=O)O)=CC=C1S(=O)(=O)N1CCOCC1 IGXVSENNUSQCOL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- SMUTWNZQWOJRDN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 5-chloropyridine-3-carbohydrazide Chemical compound NNC(=O)C1=CN=CC(Cl)=C1 SMUTWNZQWOJRDN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- WHJKCPTVEYZNOG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 6-(hydroxymethyl)-5-methoxy-2-[4,5,6-trimethoxy-2-(methoxymethyl)oxan-3-yl]oxyoxane-3,4-diol Chemical group COCC1OC(OC)C(OC)C(OC)C1OC1C(O)C(O)C(OC)C(CO)O1 WHJKCPTVEYZNOG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 244000215068 Acacia senegal Species 0.000 description 1
- 208000004064 Acoustic Neuroma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 241000251468 Actinopterygii Species 0.000 description 1
- 210000000577 Adipose Tissue Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 229920001817 Agar Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 206010001897 Alzheimer's disease Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 241000269328 Amphibia Species 0.000 description 1
- 206010002224 Anaplastic astrocytoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010060971 Astrocytoma malignant Diseases 0.000 description 1
- HONIICLYMWZJFZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Azetidine Chemical compound C1CNC1 HONIICLYMWZJFZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 241000894006 Bacteria Species 0.000 description 1
- 206010004146 Basal cell carcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- SRSXLGNVWSONIS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Benzenesulfonic acid Chemical compound OS(=O)(=O)C1=CC=CC=C1 SRSXLGNVWSONIS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 206010005003 Bladder cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010005949 Bone cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010006143 Brain stem glioma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- ZQAYLTHKLYBTAW-LICLKQGHSA-N CHEMBL3104249 Chemical compound C=1C(Cl)=CC=C(O)C=1C(/C)=N/NC(=O)C1=CC=CC=C1 ZQAYLTHKLYBTAW-LICLKQGHSA-N 0.000 description 1
- OEYIOHPDSNJKLS-UHFFFAOYSA-N C[N+](C)(C)CCO Chemical compound C[N+](C)(C)CCO OEYIOHPDSNJKLS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 208000005623 Carcinogenesis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010073130 Central nervous system neuroblastoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010008342 Cervix carcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229940068682 Chewable Tablet Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229960004926 Chlorobutanol Drugs 0.000 description 1
- OSASVXMJTNOKOY-UHFFFAOYSA-N Chlorobutanol Chemical compound CC(C)(O)C(Cl)(Cl)Cl OSASVXMJTNOKOY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229960001231 Choline Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 208000005243 Chondrosarcoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000006332 Choriocarcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000006571 Choroid Plexus Carcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000004378 Choroid Plexus Papilloma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000001333 Colorectal Neoplasms Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229920002261 Corn starch Polymers 0.000 description 1
- JYGXADMDTFJGBT-VWUMJDOOSA-N Cortisol Chemical compound O=C1CC[C@]2(C)[C@H]3[C@@H](O)C[C@](C)([C@@](CC4)(O)C(=O)CO)[C@@H]4[C@@H]3CCC2=C1 JYGXADMDTFJGBT-VWUMJDOOSA-N 0.000 description 1
- LMGZGXSXHCMSAA-UHFFFAOYSA-N Cyclodecane Chemical compound C1CCCCCCCCC1 LMGZGXSXHCMSAA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- DDTBPAQBQHZRDW-UHFFFAOYSA-N Cyclododecane Chemical compound C1CCCCCCCCCCC1 DDTBPAQBQHZRDW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- GPTJTTCOVDDHER-UHFFFAOYSA-N Cyclononane Chemical compound C1CCCCCCCC1 GPTJTTCOVDDHER-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- KYTNZWVKKKJXFS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Cycloundecane Chemical compound C1CCCCCCCCCC1 KYTNZWVKKKJXFS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- IGXWBGJHJZYPQS-SSDOTTSWSA-N D-Luciferin Chemical compound OC(=O)[C@H]1CSC(C=2SC3=CC=C(O)C=C3N=2)=N1 IGXWBGJHJZYPQS-SSDOTTSWSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 241000252212 Danio rerio Species 0.000 description 1
- HPNMFZURTQLUMO-UHFFFAOYSA-N Diethylamine Chemical compound CCNCC HPNMFZURTQLUMO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- BFSVOASYOCHEOV-UHFFFAOYSA-N Diethylethanolamine Chemical compound CCN(CC)CCO BFSVOASYOCHEOV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- USIUVYZYUHIAEV-UHFFFAOYSA-N Diphenyl ether Chemical compound C=1C=CC=CC=1OC1=CC=CC=C1 USIUVYZYUHIAEV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000006144 Dulbecco’s modified Eagle's medium Substances 0.000 description 1
- 101700009373 EHMT2 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101700025368 ERBB2 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102100016662 ERBB2 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 206010063045 Effusion Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 210000004696 Endometrium Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 241000283086 Equidae Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000283073 Equus caballus Species 0.000 description 1
- LVGKNOAMLMIIKO-QXMHVHEDSA-N Ethyl oleate Chemical compound CCCCCCCC\C=C/CCCCCCCC(=O)OCC LVGKNOAMLMIIKO-QXMHVHEDSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 210000003754 Fetus Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 241000233866 Fungi Species 0.000 description 1
- JKFAIQOWCVVSKC-UHFFFAOYSA-N Furazan Chemical compound C=1C=NON=1 JKFAIQOWCVVSKC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000005526 G1 to G0 transition Effects 0.000 description 1
- GYHNNYVSQQEPJS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Gallium Chemical compound [Ga] GYHNNYVSQQEPJS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- CEAZRRDELHUEMR-URQXQFDESA-N Gentamicin Chemical compound O1[C@H](C(C)NC)CC[C@@H](N)[C@H]1O[C@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](O[C@@H]2[C@@H]([C@@H](NC)[C@@](C)(O)CO2)O)[C@H](N)C[C@@H]1N CEAZRRDELHUEMR-URQXQFDESA-N 0.000 description 1
- 208000000527 Germinoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000005017 Glioblastoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010068601 Glioneuronal tumour Diseases 0.000 description 1
- RGHNJXZEOKUKBD-SQOUGZDYSA-N Gluconic acid Chemical compound OC[C@@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)C(O)=O RGHNJXZEOKUKBD-SQOUGZDYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229960002442 Glucosamine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- RWSXRVCMGQZWBV-WDSKDSINSA-N Glutathione Chemical compound OC(=O)[C@@H](N)CCC(=O)N[C@@H](CS)C(=O)NCC(O)=O RWSXRVCMGQZWBV-WDSKDSINSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229960003180 Glutathione Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 108010024636 Glutathione Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 229920000084 Gum arabic Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 241000238631 Hexapoda Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000282412 Homo Species 0.000 description 1
- 102000004877 Insulin Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108090001061 Insulin Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 229920002459 Intron Polymers 0.000 description 1
- JJWLVOIRVHMVIS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Isopropylamine Chemical compound CC(C)N JJWLVOIRVHMVIS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ZLTPDFXIESTBQG-UHFFFAOYSA-N Isothiazole Chemical compound C=1C=NSC=1 ZLTPDFXIESTBQG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- CTAPFRYPJLPFDF-UHFFFAOYSA-N Isoxazole Chemical compound C=1C=NOC=1 CTAPFRYPJLPFDF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 101700055132 KDM4A Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102100019932 KDM4A Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 101700002638 KDM4B Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102100019931 KDM4B Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 101700053347 KDM4C Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102100010207 KDM4C Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 101700025489 KDM4D Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102100010206 KDM4D Human genes 0.000 description 1
- HNDVDQJCIGZPNO-YFKPBYRVSA-N L-histidine Chemical compound OC(=O)[C@@H](N)CC1=CN=CN1 HNDVDQJCIGZPNO-YFKPBYRVSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 101700047494 LDL1 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 101700049988 LDL2 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 229940041476 Lactose 100 MG Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 206010023825 Laryngeal cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229940067606 Lecithin Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 241000270322 Lepidosauria Species 0.000 description 1
- 240000007472 Leucaena leucocephala Species 0.000 description 1
- 235000010643 Leucaena leucocephala Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 210000000088 Lip Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 235000019759 Maize starch Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- MBBZMMPHUWSWHV-BDVNFPICSA-N Meglumine Chemical compound CNC[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](O)[C@H](O)CO MBBZMMPHUWSWHV-BDVNFPICSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 206010027191 Meningioma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010027476 Metastasis Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 108009000215 Metastatic brain tumor Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 206010061289 Metastatic neoplasm Diseases 0.000 description 1
- LXCFILQKKLGQFO-UHFFFAOYSA-N Methylparaben Chemical compound COC(=O)C1=CC=C(O)C=C1 LXCFILQKKLGQFO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229920000168 Microcrystalline cellulose Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 238000006751 Mitsunobu reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 210000000214 Mouth Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 241000699660 Mus musculus Species 0.000 description 1
- ACTNHJDHMQSOGL-UHFFFAOYSA-N N',N'-dibenzylethane-1,2-diamine Chemical compound C=1C=CC=CC=1CN(CCN)CC1=CC=CC=C1 ACTNHJDHMQSOGL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- KDWONOMCUJBXEF-UHFFFAOYSA-N N'-[1-(2-hydroxy-6-oxocyclohexa-2,4-dien-1-ylidene)ethyl]benzohydrazide Chemical compound OC1=CC=CC(=O)C1=C(C)NNC(=O)C1=CC=CC=C1 KDWONOMCUJBXEF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- UEEJHVSXFDXPFK-UHFFFAOYSA-N N-dimethylaminoethanol Chemical compound CN(C)CCO UEEJHVSXFDXPFK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- HTLZVHNRZJPSMI-UHFFFAOYSA-N N-ethylpiperidine Chemical compound CCN1CCCCC1 HTLZVHNRZJPSMI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000001204 N-oxides Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 238000005481 NMR spectroscopy Methods 0.000 description 1
- 101700012744 NSD3 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102100020121 NSD3 Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 210000003739 Neck Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 208000007538 Neurilemmoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000002154 Non-Small-Cell Lung Carcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 108009000071 Non-small cell lung cancer Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 229920001850 Nucleic acid sequence Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 206010030155 Oesophageal carcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000008511 Optic Nerve Glioma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010073338 Optic glioma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229940100692 Oral Suspension Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 208000007312 Paraganglioma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010061332 Paraganglion neoplasm Diseases 0.000 description 1
- DPWPWRLQFGFJFI-UHFFFAOYSA-N Pargyline Chemical compound C#CCN(C)CC1=CC=CC=C1 DPWPWRLQFGFJFI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229960001779 Pargyline Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 235000019483 Peanut oil Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 210000003800 Pharynx Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 206010050487 Pinealoblastoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010035059 Pineocytoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010061538 Pituitary tumour benign Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000007452 Plasmacytoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 208000002151 Pleural Effusion Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229920003171 Poly (ethylene oxide) Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920002732 Polyanhydride Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920001748 Polybutylene Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920000954 Polyglycolide Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920001710 Polyorthoester Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920001451 Polypropylene glycol Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 241000048284 Potato virus P Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000288906 Primates Species 0.000 description 1
- MFDFERRIHVXMIY-UHFFFAOYSA-N Procaine Chemical compound CCN(CC)CCOC(=O)C1=CC=C(N)C=C1 MFDFERRIHVXMIY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- PBMFSQRYOILNGV-UHFFFAOYSA-N Pyridazine Chemical compound C1=CC=NN=C1 PBMFSQRYOILNGV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 101710037934 QRSL1 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 241000700159 Rattus Species 0.000 description 1
- 206010038038 Rectal cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 206010038389 Renal cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 101700032951 SWM1 Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 206010039667 Schwannoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 210000002966 Serum Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 241001243925 Sia Species 0.000 description 1
- 208000000587 Small Cell Lung Carcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 108009000491 Small cell lung cancer Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 206010041067 Small cell lung cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229940005550 Sodium alginate Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229940075582 Sorbic Acid Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 206010041823 Squamous cell carcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 235000021355 Stearic acid Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 208000001662 Subependymal Glioma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 241000282887 Suidae Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000282898 Sus scrofa Species 0.000 description 1
- 241000255588 Tephritidae Species 0.000 description 1
- 229960004559 Theobromine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 230000036335 Tissue distribution Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000002105 Tongue Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- GETQZCLCWQTVFV-UHFFFAOYSA-N Trimethylamine Chemical compound CN(C)C GETQZCLCWQTVFV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229940035504 Tromethamine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 210000003932 Urinary Bladder Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 206010046766 Uterine cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 241000251539 Vertebrata <Metazoa> Species 0.000 description 1
- FEWJPZIEWOKRBE-UHFFFAOYSA-N [H+].[H+].[O-]C(=O)C(O)C(O)C([O-])=O Chemical class [H+].[H+].[O-]C(=O)C(O)C(O)C([O-])=O FEWJPZIEWOKRBE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 235000010489 acacia gum Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000000205 acacia gum Substances 0.000 description 1
- 125000002777 acetyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C(*)=O 0.000 description 1
- 229910052768 actinide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000012190 activator Substances 0.000 description 1
- 125000002252 acyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 125000004423 acyloxy group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 230000001058 adult Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000002411 adverse Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000000443 aerosol Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000008272 agar Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000010419 agar Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000000556 agonist Substances 0.000 description 1
- 150000001298 alcohols Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 229910052783 alkali metal Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 150000001340 alkali metals Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 229910052784 alkaline earth metal Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 150000001342 alkaline earth metals Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 150000001336 alkenes Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 125000004644 alkyl sulfinyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 125000004390 alkyl sulfonyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- XAGFODPZIPBFFR-UHFFFAOYSA-N aluminum Chemical compound [Al] XAGFODPZIPBFFR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- QGZKDVFQNNGYKY-UHFFFAOYSA-O ammonium Chemical compound [NH4+] QGZKDVFQNNGYKY-UHFFFAOYSA-O 0.000 description 1
- 150000003863 ammonium salts Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 230000003321 amplification Effects 0.000 description 1
- 102000001307 androgen receptors Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 108010080146 androgen receptors Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 239000003242 anti bacterial agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000000111 anti-oxidant Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000003429 antifungal agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000002246 antineoplastic agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000003963 antioxidant agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000006708 antioxidants Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 125000001204 arachidyl group Chemical group [H]C([*])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 125000000511 arginine group Chemical group N[C@@H](CCCNC(N)=N)C(=O)* 0.000 description 1
- RQNWIZPPADIBDY-UHFFFAOYSA-N arsenic Chemical compound [As] RQNWIZPPADIBDY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910052785 arsenic Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 125000005002 aryl methyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 239000012131 assay buffer Substances 0.000 description 1
- 201000008271 atypical teratoid rhabdoid tumor Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 230000003542 behavioural Effects 0.000 description 1
- YIYZHARUXWKUEN-UHFFFAOYSA-N benzenesulfonamide Chemical compound NS(=O)(=O)C1=CC=CC=C1.NS(=O)(=O)C1=CC=CC=C1 YIYZHARUXWKUEN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229940092714 benzenesulfonic acid Drugs 0.000 description 1
- WPYMKLBDIGXBTP-UHFFFAOYSA-N benzoic acid group Chemical group C(C1=CC=CC=C1)(=O)O WPYMKLBDIGXBTP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229960003237 betaine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 150000005347 biaryls Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 201000009036 biliary tract cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229920002988 biodegradable polymer Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 239000004621 biodegradable polymer Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000004071 biological effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000015572 biosynthetic process Effects 0.000 description 1
- 201000000053 blastoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- ZOXJGFHDIHLPTG-UHFFFAOYSA-N boron Chemical compound [B] ZOXJGFHDIHLPTG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910052796 boron Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 210000000069 breast epithelial cell Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 229910052794 bromium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 125000006309 butyl amino group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 229960001948 caffeine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- OYPRJOBELJOOCE-UHFFFAOYSA-N calcium Chemical compound [Ca] OYPRJOBELJOOCE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910052791 calcium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 159000000007 calcium salts Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- OSGAYBCDTDRGGQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N calcium;sulfuric acid Chemical compound [Ca+2].OS(O)(=O)=O OSGAYBCDTDRGGQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000004422 calculation algorithm Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000004364 calculation method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000036952 cancer formation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 125000002837 carbocyclic group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 150000001722 carbon compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- CURLTUGMZLYLDI-UHFFFAOYSA-N carbon dioxide Chemical compound O=C=O CURLTUGMZLYLDI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000001569 carbon dioxide Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910002092 carbon dioxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- OKTJSMMVPCPJKN-NJFSPNSNSA-N carbon-14 Chemical compound [14C] OKTJSMMVPCPJKN-NJFSPNSNSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000003178 carboxy group Chemical group [H]OC(*)=O 0.000 description 1
- 125000002843 carboxylic acid group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 150000001735 carboxylic acids Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 231100000504 carcinogenesis Toxicity 0.000 description 1
- 150000001768 cations Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 230000001364 causal effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 235000010980 cellulose Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000001913 cellulose Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920002678 cellulose Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 201000010702 central neurocytoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 201000007335 cerebellar astrocytoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 201000001403 cerebral neuroblastoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 201000010881 cervical cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 150000001793 charged compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 239000007910 chewable tablet Substances 0.000 description 1
- 201000005262 chondroma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 201000009047 chordoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 239000011248 coating agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000000576 coating method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229940110456 cocoa butter Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 235000019868 cocoa butter Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000005515 coenzyme Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000001149 cognitive Effects 0.000 description 1
- 201000003963 colon carcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 239000003086 colorant Substances 0.000 description 1
- 201000010989 colorectal carcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 239000007891 compressed tablet Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000007906 compression Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000005094 computer simulation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 201000010918 connective tissue cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 238000007796 conventional method Methods 0.000 description 1
- RYGMFSIKBFXOCR-UHFFFAOYSA-N copper Chemical compound [Cu] RYGMFSIKBFXOCR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000010949 copper Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052802 copper Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 238000002425 crystallisation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000005712 crystallization Effects 0.000 description 1
- 210000004748 cultured cells Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 125000001047 cyclobutenyl group Chemical group C1(=CCC1)* 0.000 description 1
- 125000003678 cyclohexadienyl group Chemical group C1(=CC=CCC1)* 0.000 description 1
- 125000000596 cyclohexenyl group Chemical group C1(=CCCCC1)* 0.000 description 1
- 125000000113 cyclohexyl group Chemical group [H]C1([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])(*)C([H])([H])C1([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 125000000058 cyclopentadienyl group Chemical group C1(=CC=CC1)* 0.000 description 1
- 125000002433 cyclopentenyl group Chemical group C1(=CCCC1)* 0.000 description 1
- 125000000298 cyclopropenyl group Chemical group [H]C1=C([H])C1([H])* 0.000 description 1
- 125000002704 decyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 1
- 230000002939 deleterious Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000001627 detrimental Effects 0.000 description 1
- YZCKVEUIGOORGS-OUBTZVSYSA-N deuterium Chemical compound [2H] YZCKVEUIGOORGS-OUBTZVSYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910052805 deuterium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 125000004915 dibutylamino group Chemical group C(CCC)N(CCCC)* 0.000 description 1
- 125000001664 diethylamino group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])N(*)C([H])([H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 125000000118 dimethyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 1
- 125000002147 dimethylamino group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])N(*)C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 125000004914 dipropylamino group Chemical group C(CC)N(CCC)* 0.000 description 1
- 229940042397 direct acting antivirals Cyclic amines Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 201000008325 diseases of cellular proliferation Diseases 0.000 description 1
- XGZRAKBCYZIBKP-UHFFFAOYSA-L disodium;dihydroxide Chemical compound [OH-].[OH-].[Na+].[Na+] XGZRAKBCYZIBKP-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 1
- 239000002612 dispersion media Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000004090 dissolution Methods 0.000 description 1
- 125000003438 dodecyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 1
- 231100000673 dose–response relationship Toxicity 0.000 description 1
- 230000003828 downregulation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000009509 drug development Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000007876 drug discovery Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000001035 drying Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000010410 dusting Methods 0.000 description 1
- 201000004428 dysembryoplastic neuroepithelial tumor Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 238000003379 elimination reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 201000008184 embryoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 239000003995 emulsifying agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 201000003914 endometrial carcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 125000002587 enol group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 238000006911 enzymatic reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000006345 epimerization reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000011067 equilibration Methods 0.000 description 1
- 201000004101 esophageal cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 108010038795 estrogen receptors Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000015694 estrogen receptors Human genes 0.000 description 1
- HZAXFHJVJLSVMW-UHFFFAOYSA-N ethanolamine Chemical compound NCCO HZAXFHJVJLSVMW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- TUCNEACPLKLKNU-UHFFFAOYSA-N ethanone Chemical compound C[C]=O TUCNEACPLKLKNU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229940093471 ethyl oleate Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 125000000031 ethylamino group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])N([H])[*] 0.000 description 1
- 239000000284 extract Substances 0.000 description 1
- CWYNVVGOOAEACU-UHFFFAOYSA-N fe2+ Chemical compound [Fe+2] CWYNVVGOOAEACU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000001605 fetal Effects 0.000 description 1
- 201000001169 fibrillary astrocytoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 238000001914 filtration Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000012530 fluid Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000007850 fluorescent dye Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000003269 fluorescent indicator Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000005755 formation reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000001640 fractional crystallisation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000012458 free base Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000012595 freezing medium Substances 0.000 description 1
- YLQBMQCUIZJEEH-UHFFFAOYSA-N furane Chemical compound C=1C=COC=1 YLQBMQCUIZJEEH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910052733 gallium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 201000005649 gangliocytoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 201000008361 ganglioneuroma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 239000007789 gas Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000002496 gastric Effects 0.000 description 1
- 108091006088 gene-regulatory proteins Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 102000034448 gene-regulatory proteins Human genes 0.000 description 1
- 230000002068 genetic Effects 0.000 description 1
- 201000003115 germ cell cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- GNPVGFCGXDBREM-UHFFFAOYSA-N germanium Chemical compound [Ge] GNPVGFCGXDBREM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910052732 germanium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 201000005409 gliomatosis cerebri Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 150000002334 glycols Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 201000011626 grade III astrocytoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 239000003979 granulating agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 201000009277 hairy cell leukemia Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 125000004438 haloalkoxy group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 238000003306 harvesting Methods 0.000 description 1
- 201000002222 hemangioblastoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 230000002440 hepatic Effects 0.000 description 1
- 125000003187 heptyl group Chemical group [H]C([*])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 125000004051 hexyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 1
- 125000001245 hexylamino group Chemical group [H]N([*])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C(C([H])([H])[H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 238000004128 high performance liquid chromatography Methods 0.000 description 1
- 125000003372 histidine group Chemical group [H]N([H])C(C(=O)O*)C([H])([H])C1=C([H])N([H])C([H])=N1 0.000 description 1
- 238000001794 hormone therapy Methods 0.000 description 1
- XGIHQYAWBCFNPY-AZOCGYLKSA-N hydrabamine Chemical compound C([C@@H]12)CC3=CC(C(C)C)=CC=C3[C@@]2(C)CCC[C@@]1(C)CNCCNC[C@@]1(C)[C@@H]2CCC3=CC(C(C)C)=CC=C3[C@@]2(C)CCC1 XGIHQYAWBCFNPY-AZOCGYLKSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000004677 hydrates Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 229960000890 hydrocortisone Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 238000006460 hydrolysis reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 235000010979 hydroxypropyl methyl cellulose Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000001866 hydroxypropyl methyl cellulose Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920003088 hydroxypropyl methyl cellulose Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 239000003701 inert diluent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000003999 initiator Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000003780 insertion Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000000543 intermediate Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000001361 intraarterial administration Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000007915 intraurethral administration Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000003456 ion exchange resin Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000005040 ion trap Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229920003303 ion-exchange polymer Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 150000002500 ions Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 125000006316 iso-butyl amino group Chemical group [H]N(*)C([H])([H])C([H])(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 125000001972 isopentyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 1
- 239000007951 isotonicity adjuster Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000000155 isotopic Effects 0.000 description 1
- 201000000573 juvenile pilocytic astrocytoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 125000000468 ketone group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 150000002576 ketones Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 201000010982 kidney cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229910052747 lanthanoid Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 150000002602 lanthanoids Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 201000004962 larynx cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 235000010445 lecithin Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000000787 lecithin Substances 0.000 description 1
- 125000002463 lignoceryl group Chemical group [H]C([*])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 239000002502 liposome Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000004895 liquid chromatography mass spectrometry Methods 0.000 description 1
- 235000014666 liquid concentrate Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- WHXSMMKQMYFTQS-UHFFFAOYSA-N lithium Chemical compound [Li] WHXSMMKQMYFTQS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910052744 lithium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 244000144972 livestock Species 0.000 description 1
- 239000006210 lotion Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000006166 lysate Substances 0.000 description 1
- FYYHWMGAXLPEAU-UHFFFAOYSA-N magnesium Chemical compound [Mg] FYYHWMGAXLPEAU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000011777 magnesium Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052749 magnesium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 159000000003 magnesium salts Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- PWHULOQIROXLJO-UHFFFAOYSA-N manganese Chemical compound [Mn] PWHULOQIROXLJO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910052748 manganese Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000011572 manganese Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000004949 mass spectrometry Methods 0.000 description 1
- 108010082117 matrigel Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 229910052752 metalloid Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 150000002738 metalloids Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 150000002739 metals Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 230000001394 metastastic Effects 0.000 description 1
- FJLVVZZMDOHEEM-UHFFFAOYSA-N methyl 2-morpholin-4-ylsulfonylbenzoate Chemical compound COC(=O)C1=CC=CC=C1S(=O)(=O)N1CCOCC1 FJLVVZZMDOHEEM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- LMKSOKDDRYIVJY-UHFFFAOYSA-N methyl 3-(4-methylpiperazin-1-yl)sulfonylbenzoate Chemical compound COC(=O)C1=CC=CC(S(=O)(=O)N2CCN(C)CC2)=C1 LMKSOKDDRYIVJY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- QJLLSNKBORJJHO-UHFFFAOYSA-N methyl 3-methylsulfonylbenzoate Chemical compound COC(=O)C1=CC=CC(S(C)(=O)=O)=C1 QJLLSNKBORJJHO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- UZHOTUXOPYLESN-UHFFFAOYSA-N methyl 3-morpholin-4-ylbenzoate Chemical compound COC(=O)C1=CC=CC(N2CCOCC2)=C1 UZHOTUXOPYLESN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- MZVFVRZACUFIER-UHFFFAOYSA-N methyl 3-piperidin-1-ylsulfonylbenzoate Chemical compound COC(=O)C1=CC=CC(S(=O)(=O)N2CCCCC2)=C1 MZVFVRZACUFIER-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- KZKQGUVWZYKJBN-UHFFFAOYSA-N methyl 5-methylsulfonylpyridine-3-carboxylate Chemical compound COC(=O)C1=CN=CC(S(C)(=O)=O)=C1 KZKQGUVWZYKJBN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229920000609 methyl cellulose Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 125000000250 methylamino group Chemical group [H]N(*)C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 235000010981 methylcellulose Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000001923 methylcellulose Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000004530 micro-emulsion Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000008108 microcrystalline cellulose Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229940016286 microcrystalline cellulose Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 235000019813 microcrystalline cellulose Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 150000007522 mineralic acids Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 201000004058 mixed glioma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 238000002156 mixing Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000007932 molded tablet Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000000302 molecular modelling Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000002899 monoamine oxidase inhibitor Substances 0.000 description 1
- 150000004682 monohydrates Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 239000002324 mouth wash Substances 0.000 description 1
- 201000009251 multiple myeloma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 230000035772 mutation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 125000001421 myristyl group Chemical group [H]C([*])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 230000013152 negative regulation of cell migration Effects 0.000 description 1
- 125000000449 nitro group Chemical group [O-][N+](*)=O 0.000 description 1
- 229910052756 noble gas Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 125000006574 non-aromatic ring group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 239000012457 nonaqueous media Substances 0.000 description 1
- 125000001400 nonyl group Chemical group [H]C([*])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 125000003518 norbornenyl group Chemical group C12(C=CC(CC1)C2)* 0.000 description 1
- 125000002868 norbornyl group Chemical group C12(CCC(CC1)C2)* 0.000 description 1
- 108091007912 nuclear estrogen receptors Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 238000003199 nucleic acid amplification method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000007764 o/w emulsion Substances 0.000 description 1
- OIPZNTLJVJGRCI-UHFFFAOYSA-M octadecanoyloxyaluminum;dihydrate Chemical compound O.O.CCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCCC(=O)O[Al] OIPZNTLJVJGRCI-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 1
- 125000002347 octyl group Chemical group [H]C([*])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 230000003287 optical Effects 0.000 description 1
- 201000005443 oral cavity cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 239000006186 oral dosage form Substances 0.000 description 1
- 150000007524 organic acids Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 235000005985 organic acids Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 150000007530 organic bases Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 150000002895 organic esters Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 238000006053 organic reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- WCPAKWJPBJAGKN-UHFFFAOYSA-N oxadiazole Chemical compound C1=CON=N1 WCPAKWJPBJAGKN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000003002 pH adjusting agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 125000000913 palmityl group Chemical group [H]C([*])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 230000037361 pathway Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000000312 peanut oil Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000010987 pectin Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000001814 pectin Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920001277 pectin Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 125000004894 pentylamino group Chemical group C(CCCC)N* 0.000 description 1
- 230000000144 pharmacologic effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229960003742 phenol Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 125000001997 phenyl group Chemical group [H]C1=C([H])C([H])=C(*)C([H])=C1[H] 0.000 description 1
- ABLZXFCXXLZCGV-UHFFFAOYSA-N phosphorous acid Chemical compound OP(O)=O ABLZXFCXXLZCGV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000006366 phosphorylation reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000000865 phosphorylative Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000000704 physical effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000004962 physiological condition Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000002504 physiological saline solution Substances 0.000 description 1
- 201000003113 pineoblastoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 201000005746 pituitary adenoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 235000013855 polyvinylpyrrolidone Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 230000004481 post-translational protein modification Effects 0.000 description 1
- ZLMJMSJWJFRBEC-UHFFFAOYSA-N potassium Chemical compound [K] ZLMJMSJWJFRBEC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000011591 potassium Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052700 potassium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 159000000001 potassium salts Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- OFPTZWGZSRJCOT-MSPNRCMCSA-M potassium;2-[(1S,2S,3R,4S,5S,6R)-3-(diaminomethylideneamino)-4-[(2R,3R,4R,5S)-3-[(2S,3S,4S,5R,6S)-4,5-dihydroxy-6-(hydroxymethyl)-3-(methylamino)oxan-2-yl]oxy-4-formyl-4-hydroxy-5-methyloxolan-2-yl]oxy-2,5,6-trihydroxycyclohexyl]guanidine;(2S,5R,6R)-3,3-d Chemical compound [K+].N([C@H]1[C@H]2SC([C@@H](N2C1=O)C([O-])=O)(C)C)C(=O)CC1=CC=CC=C1.CN[C@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](O)[C@H](CO)O[C@H]1O[C@@H]1[C@](C=O)(O)[C@H](C)O[C@H]1O[C@H]1[C@H](N=C(N)N)[C@@H](O)[C@H](N=C(N)N)[C@@H](O)[C@@H]1O OFPTZWGZSRJCOT-MSPNRCMCSA-M 0.000 description 1
- 229920001592 potato starch Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 235000014483 powder concentrate Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- OZAIFHULBGXAKX-UHFFFAOYSA-N precursor Substances N#CC(C)(C)N=NC(C)(C)C#N OZAIFHULBGXAKX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000003141 primary amines Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 238000002810 primary assay Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229960004919 procaine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 230000002035 prolonged Effects 0.000 description 1
- 125000006308 propyl amino group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 201000005825 prostate adenocarcinoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 230000002633 protecting Effects 0.000 description 1
- 150000003212 purines Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- KYQCOXFCLRTKLS-UHFFFAOYSA-N pyrazine Chemical compound C1=CN=CC=N1 KYQCOXFCLRTKLS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- WTKZEGDFNFYCGP-UHFFFAOYSA-N pyrazole Chemical compound C=1C=NNC=1 WTKZEGDFNFYCGP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- KAESVJOAVNADME-UHFFFAOYSA-N pyrrole Chemical compound C=1C=CNC=1 KAESVJOAVNADME-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000002285 radioactive Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000001959 radiotherapy Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000005295 random walk Methods 0.000 description 1
- 201000001275 rectum cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 230000014493 regulation of gene expression Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000000754 repressing Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000011347 resin Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920005989 resin Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 210000002345 respiratory system Anatomy 0.000 description 1
- 230000000717 retained Effects 0.000 description 1
- 201000000582 retinoblastoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 238000010839 reverse transcription Methods 0.000 description 1
- 201000009410 rhabdomyosarcoma Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 238000007363 ring formation reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 150000003335 secondary amines Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- BUGBHKTXTAQXES-UHFFFAOYSA-N selenium Chemical compound [Se] BUGBHKTXTAQXES-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910052711 selenium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000011669 selenium Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000007493 shaping process Methods 0.000 description 1
- 231100000486 side effect Toxicity 0.000 description 1
- 229910052710 silicon Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000010703 silicon Substances 0.000 description 1
- XUIMIQQOPSSXEZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N silicon Chemical compound [Si] XUIMIQQOPSSXEZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000000377 silicon dioxide Substances 0.000 description 1
- 125000003808 silyl group Chemical group [H][Si]([H])([H])[*] 0.000 description 1
- 235000020374 simple syrup Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 201000000849 skin cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- KEAYESYHFKHZAL-UHFFFAOYSA-N sodium Chemical compound [Na] KEAYESYHFKHZAL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000011734 sodium Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052708 sodium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- MSXHSNHNTORCAW-UHFFFAOYSA-M sodium 3,4,5,6-tetrahydroxyoxane-2-carboxylate Chemical compound [Na+].OC1OC(C([O-])=O)C(O)C(O)C1O MSXHSNHNTORCAW-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 1
- 235000010413 sodium alginate Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000000661 sodium alginate Substances 0.000 description 1
- 159000000000 sodium salts Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 239000008247 solid mixture Substances 0.000 description 1
- WSWCOQWTEOXDQX-UHFFFAOYSA-N sorbic acid Chemical compound CC=CC=CC(O)=O WSWCOQWTEOXDQX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000004334 sorbic acid Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000010199 sorbic acid Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000008117 stearic acid Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000003206 sterilizing agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000003860 storage Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000010254 subcutaneous injection Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000007929 subcutaneous injection Substances 0.000 description 1
- 125000005017 substituted alkenyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 125000003107 substituted aryl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 230000000153 supplemental Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000003319 supportive Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000001356 surgical procedure Methods 0.000 description 1
- 235000002906 tartaric acid Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 229910052714 tellurium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- PORWMNRCUJJQNO-UHFFFAOYSA-N tellurium Chemical compound [Te] PORWMNRCUJJQNO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000003512 tertiary amines Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- DPOPAJRDYZGTIR-UHFFFAOYSA-N tetrazine Chemical compound C1=CN=NN=N1 DPOPAJRDYZGTIR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000003536 tetrazoles Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- FZWLAAWBMGSTSO-UHFFFAOYSA-N thiazole Chemical compound C1=CSC=N1 FZWLAAWBMGSTSO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000002562 thickening agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 125000004001 thioalkyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 150000003568 thioethers Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- YTPLMLYBLZKORZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N thiophene Chemical compound C=1C=CSC=1 YTPLMLYBLZKORZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 201000002510 thyroid cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 229910052718 tin Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- ATJFFYVFTNAWJD-UHFFFAOYSA-N tin hydride Chemical compound [Sn] ATJFFYVFTNAWJD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000035897 transcription Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000000844 transformation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229910052723 transition metal Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 150000003624 transition metals Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- BSUNTQCMCCQSQH-UHFFFAOYSA-N triazine Chemical compound C1=CN=NN=C1.C1=CN=NN=C1 BSUNTQCMCCQSQH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000003852 triazoles Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- YFTHZRPMJXBUME-UHFFFAOYSA-N tripropylamine Chemical compound CCCN(CCC)CCC YFTHZRPMJXBUME-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000002221 trityl group Chemical group [H]C1=C([H])C([H])=C([H])C([H])=C1C([*])(C1=C(C(=C(C(=C1[H])[H])[H])[H])[H])C1=C([H])C([H])=C([H])C([H])=C1[H] 0.000 description 1
- 229960000281 trometamol Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 230000004614 tumor growth Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000010798 ubiquitination Methods 0.000 description 1
- 241000701447 unidentified baculovirus Species 0.000 description 1
- 230000003827 upregulation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000011144 upstream manufacturing Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000002485 urinary Effects 0.000 description 1
- 201000005112 urinary bladder cancer Diseases 0.000 description 1
- 231100000747 viability assay Toxicity 0.000 description 1
- 238000003026 viability measurement method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000000007 visual effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 230000003442 weekly Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000000080 wetting agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000230 xanthan gum Substances 0.000 description 1
- 235000010493 xanthan gum Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 229920001285 xanthan gum Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229940082509 xanthan gum Drugs 0.000 description 1
Classifications
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61K—PREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
- A61K31/00—Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
- A61K31/16—Amides, e.g. hydroxamic acids
- A61K31/18—Sulfonamides
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61K—PREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
- A61K31/00—Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
- A61K31/33—Heterocyclic compounds
- A61K31/395—Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
- A61K31/397—Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having four-membered rings, e.g. azetidine
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61K—PREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
- A61K31/00—Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
- A61K31/33—Heterocyclic compounds
- A61K31/395—Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
- A61K31/40—Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having five-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom, e.g. sulpiride, succinimide, tolmetin, buflomedil
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61K—PREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
- A61K31/00—Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
- A61K31/33—Heterocyclic compounds
- A61K31/395—Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
- A61K31/435—Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with one nitrogen as the only ring hetero atom
- A61K31/44—Non condensed pyridines; Hydrogenated derivatives thereof
- A61K31/445—Non condensed piperidines, e.g. piperocaine
- A61K31/4453—Non condensed piperidines, e.g. piperocaine only substituted in position 1, e.g. propipocaine, diperodon
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61K—PREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
- A61K31/00—Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
- A61K31/33—Heterocyclic compounds
- A61K31/395—Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
- A61K31/495—Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61K—PREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
- A61K31/00—Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
- A61K31/33—Heterocyclic compounds
- A61K31/395—Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
- A61K31/535—Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with at least one nitrogen and one oxygen as the ring hetero atoms, e.g. 1,2-oxazines
- A61K31/5375—1,4-Oxazines, e.g. morpholine
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61K—PREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
- A61K31/00—Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
- A61K31/33—Heterocyclic compounds
- A61K31/395—Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
- A61K31/535—Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with at least one nitrogen and one oxygen as the ring hetero atoms, e.g. 1,2-oxazines
- A61K31/5375—1,4-Oxazines, e.g. morpholine
- A61K31/5377—1,4-Oxazines, e.g. morpholine not condensed and containing further heterocyclic rings, e.g. timolol
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61P—SPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
- A61P35/00—Antineoplastic agents
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07C—ACYCLIC OR CARBOCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
- C07C311/00—Amides of sulfonic acids, i.e. compounds having singly-bound oxygen atoms of sulfo groups replaced by nitrogen atoms, not being part of nitro or nitroso groups
- C07C311/15—Sulfonamides having sulfur atoms of sulfonamide groups bound to carbon atoms of six-membered aromatic rings
- C07C311/16—Sulfonamides having sulfur atoms of sulfonamide groups bound to carbon atoms of six-membered aromatic rings having the nitrogen atom of at least one of the sulfonamide groups bound to hydrogen atoms or to an acyclic carbon atom
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07C—ACYCLIC OR CARBOCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
- C07C311/00—Amides of sulfonic acids, i.e. compounds having singly-bound oxygen atoms of sulfo groups replaced by nitrogen atoms, not being part of nitro or nitroso groups
- C07C311/30—Sulfonamides, the carbon skeleton of the acid part being further substituted by singly-bound nitrogen atoms, not being part of nitro or nitroso groups
- C07C311/45—Sulfonamides, the carbon skeleton of the acid part being further substituted by singly-bound nitrogen atoms, not being part of nitro or nitroso groups at least one of the singly-bound nitrogen atoms being part of any of the groups, X being a hetero atom, Y being any atom, e.g. N-acylaminosulfonamides
- C07C311/46—Y being a hydrogen or a carbon atom
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07D—HETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
- C07D205/00—Heterocyclic compounds containing four-membered rings with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom
- C07D205/02—Heterocyclic compounds containing four-membered rings with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom not condensed with other rings
- C07D205/04—Heterocyclic compounds containing four-membered rings with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom not condensed with other rings having no double bonds between ring members or between ring members and non-ring members
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07D—HETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
- C07D295/00—Heterocyclic compounds containing polymethylene-imine rings with at least five ring members, 3-azabicyclo [3.2.2] nonane, piperazine, morpholine or thiomorpholine rings, having only hydrogen atoms directly attached to the ring carbon atoms
- C07D295/04—Heterocyclic compounds containing polymethylene-imine rings with at least five ring members, 3-azabicyclo [3.2.2] nonane, piperazine, morpholine or thiomorpholine rings, having only hydrogen atoms directly attached to the ring carbon atoms with substituted hydrocarbon radicals attached to ring nitrogen atoms
- C07D295/14—Heterocyclic compounds containing polymethylene-imine rings with at least five ring members, 3-azabicyclo [3.2.2] nonane, piperazine, morpholine or thiomorpholine rings, having only hydrogen atoms directly attached to the ring carbon atoms with substituted hydrocarbon radicals attached to ring nitrogen atoms substituted by carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals
- C07D295/155—Heterocyclic compounds containing polymethylene-imine rings with at least five ring members, 3-azabicyclo [3.2.2] nonane, piperazine, morpholine or thiomorpholine rings, having only hydrogen atoms directly attached to the ring carbon atoms with substituted hydrocarbon radicals attached to ring nitrogen atoms substituted by carbon atoms having three bonds to hetero atoms with at the most one bond to halogen, e.g. ester or nitrile radicals with the ring nitrogen atoms and the carbon atoms with three bonds to hetero atoms separated by carbocyclic rings or by carbon chains interrupted by carbocyclic rings
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07D—HETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
- C07D295/00—Heterocyclic compounds containing polymethylene-imine rings with at least five ring members, 3-azabicyclo [3.2.2] nonane, piperazine, morpholine or thiomorpholine rings, having only hydrogen atoms directly attached to the ring carbon atoms
- C07D295/22—Heterocyclic compounds containing polymethylene-imine rings with at least five ring members, 3-azabicyclo [3.2.2] nonane, piperazine, morpholine or thiomorpholine rings, having only hydrogen atoms directly attached to the ring carbon atoms with hetero atoms directly attached to ring nitrogen atoms
- C07D295/26—Sulfur atoms
Abstract
Provided are substituted (E)-N'-(1-phenylethylidene) benzohydrazide analogue compounds, of the general formula (I), wherein the variables are as defined in the specification. Examples of the compounds include (E)-N'-(1-(5-chloro-2-hydroxyphenyl)ethylidene)-3-(morpholinosulfonyl)benzohydrazide and (E)-3-(2-(1-(5-chloro-2-hydroxyphenyl)ethylidene)hydrazinecarbonyl)-N-methylbenzenesulfonamide. The compounds are lysine-specific demethylase inhibitors. The compounds may be useful in the treatment of cancer. )-3-(2-(1-(5-chloro-2-hydroxyphenyl)ethylidene)hydrazinecarbonyl)-N-methylbenzenesulfonamide. The compounds are lysine-specific demethylase inhibitors. The compounds may be useful in the treatment of cancer.
Description
SUBSTITUTED (E)- N’-(1-PHENYLETHYLIDENE)BENZOHYDRAZIDE ANALOGS
AS HISTONE DEMETHYLASE INHIBITORS
BACKGROUND
Over the past decade it has become clear that epigenetic changes,
which alter gene activity without altering DNA sequence, collaborate with genetic
mistakes to promote cancer development and progression (Tsai, H. C. and Baylin,
S. B. Cell Res 2011, 21 (3), 502-17; and Fullgrabe, J., Kavanagh, E., and Joseph,
B. Oncogene 2011). The regulation of the modifications on DNA and the proteins
associated with DNA has become an area of intense interest and the enzymes
involved in these processes have been suggested as a new class of protein targets
for drug development. The major proteins associated with DNA are histone proteins.
Histone tails are subject to a variety of posttranslational modifications, such as
phosphorylation, acetylation, methylation, and ubiquitination, and these
modifications, especially acetylation and methylation on lysine residues, play a major
role in the regulation of gene expression, and are often dysregulated in cancer
(Fullgrabe, J., Kavanagh, E., and Joseph, B. Oncogene 2011).
Recently an enzyme called Lysine-Specific Demethylase 1 (LSD1) was
found to catalyze the oxidative demethylation of monomethylated and dimethylated
histone H3 at lysine 4 (H3K4me1 and H3K4me2) and lysine 9 (H3K9me1 and
H3K9me2) through a flavin adenine dinucleotide (FAD)-dependent reaction (Shi, Y.,
et al. Cell 2004, 119 (7), 941-53; and Metzger, E., et al. Nature 2005, 437 (7057),
436-9), Whereas histone acetylation is associated with loose chromatin and gene
activation, methylation of histones is less straightforward. Using the lysine residues
regulated by LSD1 as an example, methylation at H3K4 is generally associated with
gene activation, while methylation of H3K9 is associated with transcriptional
repression.
There is currently one known mammalian homolog of LSD1 which is a
protein variously designated LSD2, KDM1b, and AOF1. It shares a similar domain
homology, but exhibits less than 31% sequence identity (Fang, R. et al. Molecular
Cell 2010, 39:222-233). It has been shown that LSD2 is a H3K4me1/2 demethylase
that specifically regulates histone H3K4 methylation within intragenic regions of its
— 1 —
target genes (ibid.). Both LSD1 and LSD2 contain a SWIRM domain, a FAD
coenzyme-binding motif, and a C-terminal amine oxidase domain, all of which are
critical to the enzymatic activity. However, unlike LSD1, the protein LSD2 contains a
CW-type zinc finger domain in its N-terminal domain, a region which is unstructured
in LSD1. Furthermore, LSD2 lacks the ―tower domain‖ of LSD1. At a cellular level, it
has been suggested that LSD2 has a role in transcriptional regulation (ibid.). As
expected, LSD2 appears to play a role in regulating DNA methylation as well,
although the role in DNA methylation may be developmental stage specific (ibid.;
Ciccone, D.N., et al. Nature 2009 461:415-418; Karytinos, A., et al. J. Biol. Chem.
2009 284:17775-17782; and Yang, Z., et al. Cell Res. 2010 20:276-287).
Several lines of evidence point to LSD1 as being a possible
therapeutic target in cancer. LSD1 is reportedly over-expressed in a variety of
tumors including neuroblastoma, ER-negative breast, bladder, lung, and colorectal
tumors (Schulte, J. H., et al. Cancer Res 2009, 69 (5), 2065-71; Lim, S., et al.
Carcinogenesis 2010, 31 (3), 512-20; and Hayami, S., et al. Int J Cancer 2011, 128
(3), 574-86). Increased methylation of the permissive H3K4 mark by LSD1 inhibition
has been shown to reactivate expression of tumor suppressor genes in cancer
models (Huang, Y., et al. Clin Cancer Res 2009, 15 (23), 7217-28). In addition,
LSD1 has been found to associate with estrogen and androgen receptors leading to
the specific demethylation of the repressive H3K9 mark, thereby increasing target
gene expression (Metzger, E., et al. Nature 2005, 437 (7057), 436-9; and Garcia-
Bassets, I., et al. Cell 2007, 128 (3), 505-18). Thus, depending upon cofactors
bound to LSD1, demethylation by LSD1 can contribute to cancer through both the
permissive H3K4 and the repressive H3K9 mark. Therefore, the inhibition of LSD1
might be an effective strategy for re-expression of epigenetically silenced tumor
suppressor genes as well as down regulation of important cancer pathways in a
number of cancer types. Several LSD1 inhibitors have been reported, but they have
shown poor selectivity and/or pharmacological properties, making further exploration
of LSD1 biology difficult.
Monoamine oxidase (MAO) inhibitors such as tranylcypromine and
pargyline have been reported as LSD1 inhibitors, and there have been several
reports regarding attempts to discover derivatives with increased selectivity for LSD1
— 2 —
over MAO (Mimasu, S., et al. Biochemistry 2010, 49 (30), 6494-503; Binda, C. , et
al. J Am Chem Soc 2010, 132 (19), 6827-33; Culhane, J. C. , et al. J Am Chem Soc
2006, 128 (14), 4536-7; Culhane, J. C. , et al. J Am Chem Soc 2010, 132 (9), 3164-
76; and Ueda, R. , et al. J Am Chem Soc 2009, 131 (48), 17536-7). These
compounds irreversibly inactivate LSD1 by covalent binding to the FAD cofactor.
Polyamine derivatives have also been evaluated as LSD1 inhibitors, where
compounds with activity in the µM range have been described (Huang, Y., et al. Clin
Cancer Res 2009, 15 (23), 7217-28; Sharma, S. K., et al. J Med Chem 2010, 53
(14), 5197-212; and Huang, Y., et al. Proc Natl Acad Sci U S A 2007, 104 (19),
8023-8). In general, these and other reported LSD1 inhibitors are neither
adequately selective nor potent enough to optimally interact with the crucial amino
acid residues of the substrate-binding site present in LSD1.
In summary, the LSD proteins play a key role in epigenetic and
transcriptional regulation, and they are frequently altered in mammalian cancers,
thus making them an attractive target for therapeutic intervention. Despite advances
in drug discovery directed to identifying inhibitors of LSD1 and/or LSD2 protein
activity, there is still a scarcity of compounds that are both potent, efficacious, and
selective inhibitors of either LSD1 or LSD2. Furthermore, there is a scarcity of
compounds effective in the treatment of cancer and other diseases associated with
dysfunction in LSD1 and/or LSD2. These needs and other needs are satisfied by
the present invention. It is an object of the present invention to go some way
towards meeting this need and/or to provide the public with a useful choice.
SUMMARY
In accordance with the purpose(s) of the invention, as embodied and
broadly described herein, the invention, in one aspect, relates to compounds useful
useful as inhibitors of lysine-specific demethylase, or LSD. Specifically, the
invention provides a compound having a structure represented by a formula:
— 3 —
NH m
(I),
wherein
m is 1;
n is an integer from 0 to 3;
Z is independently selected from N and CH;
R is selected from halo, C1-C3 haloalkyl, and C1-C3 polyhaloalkyl;
each of R , R , and R is independently selected from hydrogen, halo, hydroxyl,
2 3 4
cyano, amino, C2-C6 alkalkoxy, C1-C6 alkoxy, C1-C6 alkyl, C1-C6 polyhaloalkyl,
and C1-C6 haloalkyl;
R is selected from NR and Cy, and substituted with 0-3 groups independently
selected from halo, hydroxyl, amino, cyano, C2-C6 alkalkoxy, C1-C6 alkylalcohol,
C1-C6 alkoxy, C1-C6 alkyl, C1-C6 polyhaloalkyl, C1-C6 haloalkyl, C3-C6 cycloalkyl,
and Cy;
Cy is a heterocycloalkyl selected from aziridinyl, azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl,
azepanyl, oxazolidinyl, imidazolidinyl, pyrazolidinyl, piperazinyl, oxazinanyl,
morpholinyl, hexahydrophyrimidinyl, and hexahydropyridazinyl; and
R is selected from hydrogen, C1-C6 alkyl, C3-C6 cycloalkyl, and C3-C6
heterocycloalkyl;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
[0007a] The disclosed compounds and products of disclosed methods of
making, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, hydrate, solvate, or polymorph
thereof, are modulators of LSD activity, methods of making same, pharmaceutical
compositions comprising same, and methods of treating disorders associated with a
— 4 —
LSD activity dysfunction using same. Also disclosed are compounds that bind to a
LSD protein and negatively modulate LSD activity. The disclosed compounds can,
in one aspect, exhibit subtype selectivity. In a further aspect, the disclosed
compounds exhibit selectivity for the LSD1 member of the LSD protein family. In a
still further aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit selectivity for the LSD2 member
of the LSD protein family.
Also disclosed are pharmaceutical compositions comprising a
therapeutically effective amount of a disclosed compound and a pharmaceutically
acceptable carrier.
Also disclosed are synthetic methods for making the disclosed
compounds. In a further aspect, disclosed are the products of the disclosed
synthetic methods.
Disclosed are methods for the treatment of a disorder associated with
a LSD activity dysfunction in a mammal comprising the step of administering to the
mammal a therapeutically effective amount of a disclosed compound, or a
pharmaceutically acceptable salt, hydrate, solvate, or polymorph thereof.
Also disclosed are method for inhibition of LSD activity in a mammal
comprising the step of administering to the mammal a therapeutically effective
amount of least one disclosed compound, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt,
hydrate, solvate, or polymorph thereof.
Also disclosed are methods for inhibiting LSD activity in at least one
cell, comprising the step of contacting the at least one cell with an effective amount
of least one disclosed compound, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, hydrate,
solvate, or polymorph thereof.
Also disclosed are uses of a disclosed compound, or a
pharmaceutically acceptable salt, hydrate, solvate, or polymorph thereof. In a
further aspect, the invention relates to pharmaceutical compositions comprising a
pharmaceutically acceptable carrier and an effective amount of a disclosed
compound, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, hydrate, solvate, or polymorph
thereof.
— 5 —
Also disclosed are kits comprising at least one disclosed compound, or
a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, hydrate, solvate, or polymorph thereof, and one
or more of: (a) at least one agent known to increase histone demethylase activity; (b)
at least one agent known to decrease histone demethylase activity; (c) at least one
agent known to treat a disorder of uncontrolled cellular proliferation; (d) at least one
agent known to treat a neurodegenerative disorder; (e) instructions for treating a
neurodegenerative disorder; or (f) instructions for treating a disorder associated with
uncontrolled cellular proliferation.
Also disclosed are methods for manufacturing a medicament
comprising combining at least one disclosed compound or at least one disclosed
product with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or diluent. In a further aspect, the
invention relates to the use of a disclosed compound in the manufacture of a
medicament for the treatment of a a disorder associated with a LSD activity
dysfunction. In a yet further aspect, the LSD activity dysfunction is a LSD1 activity
dysfunction. In an even further aspect, the LSD activity dysfunction is a LSD2
activity dysfunction. In a still further aspect, the invention relatees to the used of
disclosed compound in the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of a a
disorder of uncontrolled cellular proliferation.
Also disclosed are uses of a disclosed compound or a disclosed
product in the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of a disorder
associated with a LSD dysfunction in a mammal.
While aspects of the present invention can be described and claimed
in a particular statutory class, such as the system statutory class, this is for
convenience only and one of skill in the art will understand that each aspect of the
present invention can be described and claimed in any statutory class. Unless
otherwise expressly stated, it is in no way intended that any method or aspect set
forth herein be construed as requiring that its steps be performed in a specific order.
Accordingly, where a method claim does not specifically state in the claims or
descriptions that the steps are to be limited to a specific order, it is no way intended
that an order be inferred, in any respect. This holds for any possible non-express
basis for interpretation, including matters of logic with respect to arrangement of
— 6 —
steps or operational flow, plain meaning derived from grammatical organization or
punctuation, or the number or type of aspects described in the specification.
DESCRIPTION
The present invention can be understood more readily by reference to
the following detailed description of the invention and the Examples included therein.
Before the present compounds, compositions, articles, systems,
devices, and/or methods are disclosed and described, it is to be understood that
they are not limited to specific synthetic methods unless otherwise specified, or to
particular reagents unless otherwise specified, as such may, of course, vary. It is
also to be understood that the terminology used herein is for the purpose of
describing particular aspects only and is not intended to be limiting. Although any
methods and materials similar or equivalent to those described herein can be used
in the practice or testing of the present invention, example methods and materials
are now described.
All publications mentioned herein are incorporated herein by reference
to disclose and describe the methods and/or materials in connection with which the
publications are cited. The publications discussed herein are provided solely for
their disclosure prior to the filing date of the present application. Nothing herein is to
be construed as an admission that the present invention is not entitled to antedate
such publication by virtue of prior invention. Further, the dates of publication
provided herein can be different from the actual publication dates, which can require
independent confirmation.
A. DEFINITIONS
As used herein, nomenclature for compounds, including organic
compounds, can be given using common names, IUPAC, IUBMB, or CAS
recommendations for nomenclature. When one or more stereochemical features are
present, Cahn-Ingold-Prelog rules for stereochemistry can be employed to designate
stereochemical priority, E/Z specification, and the like. One of skill in the art can
readily ascertain the structure of a compound if given a name, either by systemic
— 7 —
reduction of the compound structure using naming conventions, or by commercially
available software, such as ChemDraw (Cambridgesoft Corporation, U.S.A.).
As used in the specification and the appended claims, the singular
forms ―a,‖ ―an‖ and ―the‖ include plural referents unless the context clearly dictates
otherwise. Thus, for example, reference to ―a functional group,‖ ―an alkyl,‖ or ―a
residue‖ includes mixtures of two or more such functional groups, alkyls, or residues,
and the like.
[0022a] The term ―comprising‖ as used in this specification means ―consisting
at least in part of‖. When interpreting each statement in this specification that
includes the term ―comprising‖, features other than that or those prefaced by the
term may also be present. Related terms such as ―comprise‖ and ―comprises‖ are to
be interpreted in the same manner.
Ranges can be expressed herein as from ―about‖ one particular value,
and/or to ―about‖ another particular value. When such a range is expressed, a
further aspect includes from the one particular value and/or to the other particular
value. Similarly, when values are expressed as approximations, by use of the
antecedent ―about,‖ it will be understood that the particular value forms a further
aspect. It will be further understood that the endpoints of each of the ranges are
significant both in relation to the other endpoint, and independently of the other
endpoint. It is also understood that there are a number of values disclosed herein,
and that each value is also herein disclosed as ―about‖ that particular value in
addition to the value itself. For example, if the value ―10‖ is disclosed, then ―about
‖ is also disclosed. It is also understood that each unit between two particular
units are also disclosed. For example, if 10 and 15 are disclosed, then 11, 12, 13,
and 14 are also disclosed.
References in the specification and concluding claims to parts by
weight of a particular element or component in a composition denotes the weight
relationship between the element or component and any other elements or
components in the composition or article for which a part by weight is expressed.
Thus, in a compound containing 2 parts by weight of component X and 5 parts by
weight component Y, X and Y are present at a weight ratio of 2:5, and are present in
— 8 —
such ratio regardless of whether additional components are contained in the
compound.
A weight percent (wt. %) of a component, unless specifically stated to
the contrary, is based on the total weight of the formulation or composition in which
the component is included.
As used herein, the term ―LSD‖ refers collectively to either or both
LSD1 and LSD2.
As used herein, the terms ―LSD1‖ and ―lysine-specific demethylase 1‖
can be used interchangeably and refer to a histone demethylase encoded by the
KDM1A gene. The KDM1A gene has a gene map locus of 1p36.12 as described by
the Entrez Gene cytogenetic band, Ensembl cytogenetic band, and the HGNC
cytogenetic band. The term LSD1 refers to a native protein that has 852 amino
acids with a molecular weight of about 92903 Da, and is a member of the flavin
monoamine oxidase family. The term LSD1 is inclusive of the protein, gene product
and/or gene referred to by such alternative designations as: LSD1, KDM1; RP1-
184J9.1; AOF2; BHC110; KIAA0601; LSD1; BRAF35-HDAC complex protein
BHC110; FAD-binding protein BRAF35-HDAC complex, 110 kDa subunit; amine
oxidase (flavin containing) domain 2; lysine-specific histone demethylase 1; lysine-
specific histone demethylase 1A; flavin-containing amine oxidase domain-containing
protein 2; lysine (K)-specific demethylase 1; amine oxidase (flavin containing)
domain 2; and FAD-binding protein BRAF35-HDAC complex, 110 kDa subunit, as
used by those skilled in the art.
As used herein, the terms ―LSD2 and ―lysine-specific demethylase 2
can be used interchangeably and refer to a histone demethylase encoded by the
KDM1B gene. The KDM1B gene has a gene map locus of 6p22.3 as described by
the Entrez Gene cytogenetic band, Ensembl cytogenetic band, and the HGNC
cytogenetic band. The term LSD21 refers to a native protein that has 822 amino
acids with a molecular weight of about 92098 Da, and is a member of the flavin
monoamine oxidase family. The term LSD2 is inclusive of the protein, gene product
and/or gene referred to by such alternative designations as: LSD2, AOF1;
FLJ33898; FLJ34109; FLJ43328; C6orf193; DKFZp686I0412;
— 9 —
OTTHUMP00000179125; bA204B7.3; dJ298J15.2; flavin-containing amine oxidase
domain-containing protein 1; lysine-specific histone demethylase 2; lysine (K)-
specific demethylase 1B; amine oxidase (flavin containing) domain 1; amine
oxidase, flavin containing 1; lysine-specific histone demethylase 2; chromosome 6
open reading frame 193; and lysine-specific histone demethylase 1B, as used by
those skilled in the art..
As used herein, the term ―histone demethylase‖ refers to that group of
enzymes which remove methyl groups from histone proteins. The term is inclusive
of both histone lysine demethylases, i.e. enzymes which remove methyl groups from
lysine residues in histones, and histone arginine demethylases, i.e. enzymes which
remove methyl groups from arginine residues in histones.
As used herein, the term ―histone lysine demethylase‖ or ―lysine-
specific histone demethylase‖can be used interchangeably, and both refer to that
group of enzymes which remove methyl groups from lysine residues of histone
proteins. The histone lysine demethylases are a group of enzymes which comprise
the following specific forms: LSD1, LSD2, JMJD2A, JMJD2B, JMJD2C and JMJD2D.
As used herein, the terms ―optional‖ or ―optionally‖ means that the
subsequently described event or circumstance can or can not occur, and that the
description includes instances where said event or circumstance occurs and
instances where it does not.
As used herein, the term ―subject‖ can be a vertebrate, such as a
mammal, a fish, a bird, a reptile, or an amphibian. Thus, the subject of the herein
disclosed methods can be a human, non-human primate, horse, pig, rabbit, dog,
sheep, goat, cow, cat, guinea pig or rodent. The term does not denote a particular
age or sex. Thus, adult and newborn subjects, as well as fetuses, whether male or
female, are intended to be covered. In one aspect, the subject is a mammal. A
patient refers to a subject afflicted with a disease or disorder. The term ―patient‖
includes human and veterinary subjects. In some aspects of the disclosed methods,
the subject has been diagnosed with a need for treatment of a disorder of
uncontrolled cellular proliferation associated with a histone lysine demethylase
dysfunction prior to the administering step. In some aspects of the disclosed
— 10 —
method, the subject has been diagnosed with a need for inhibition of a histone lysine
demethylase prior to the administering step.
As used herein, the term ―treatment‖ refers to the medical
management of a patient with the intent to cure, ameliorate, stabilize, or prevent a
disease, pathological condition, or disorder. This term includes active treatment,
that is, treatment directed specifically toward the improvement of a disease,
pathological condition, or disorder, and also includes causal treatment, that is,
treatment directed toward removal of the cause of the associated disease,
pathological condition, or disorder. In addition, this term includes palliative
treatment, that is, treatment designed for the relief of symptoms rather than the
curing of the disease, pathological condition, or disorder; preventative treatment, that
is, treatment directed to minimizing or partially or completely inhibiting the
development of the associated disease, pathological condition, or disorder; and
supportive treatment, that is, treatment employed to supplement another specific
therapy directed toward the improvement of the associated disease, pathological
condition, or disorder. In various aspects, the term covers any treatment of a
subject, including a mammal (e.g., a human), and includes: (i) preventing the
disease from occurring in a subject that can be predisposed to the disease but has
not yet been diagnosed as having it; (ii) inhibiting the disease, i.e., arresting its
development; or (iii) relieving the disease, i.e., causing regression of the disease. In
one aspect, the subject is a mammal such as a primate, and, in a further aspect, the
subject is a human. The term ―subject‖ also includes domesticated animals (e.g.,
cats, dogs, etc.), livestock (e.g., cattle, horses, pigs, sheep, goats, etc.), and
laboratory animals (e.g., mouse, rabbit, rat, guinea pig, fruit fly, zebra fish etc.).
As used herein, the term ―prevent‖ or ―preventing‖ refers to precluding,
averting, obviating, forestalling, stopping, or hindering something from happening,
especially by advance action. It is understood that where reduce, inhibit or prevent
are used herein, unless specifically indicated otherwise, the use of the other two
words is also expressly disclosed.
As used herein, the term ―diagnosed‖ means having been subjected to
a physical examination by a person of skill, for example, a physician, and found to
have a condition that can be diagnosed or treated by the compounds, compositions,
— 11 —
or methods disclosed herein. For example, ―diagnosed with a disorder of
uncontrolled cellular proliferation‖ means having been subjected to a physical
examination by a person of skill, for example, a physician, and found to have a
condition that can be diagnosed or treated by a compound or composition that can
inhibit a histone lysine demethylase. As a further example, ―diagnosed with a need
for inhibition of a histone demethylase‖ refers to having been subjected to a physical
examination by a person of skill, for example, a physician, and found to have a
condition characterized by a histone demethylase dysfunction. Such a diagnosis
can be in reference to a disorder, such as a disorder of uncontrolled cellular
proliferation, cancer and the like, as discussed herein. For example, the term
―diagnosed with a need for inhibition of histone demethylase activity‖ refers to having
been subjected to a physical examination by a person of skill, for example, a
physician, and found to have a condition that can be diagnosed or treated by
inhibition of histone demethylase activity. For example, ―diagnosed with a need for
treatment of one or more disorders of uncontrolled cellular proliferation associated
with a histone demethylase dysfunction‖ means having been subjected to a physical
examination by a person of skill, for example, a physician, and found to have one or
more disorders of uncontrolled cellular proliferation associated with a histone
demethylase dysfunction.
As used herein, the phrase ―identified to be in need of treatment for a
disorder,‖ or the like, refers to selection of a subject based upon need for treatment
of the disorder. For example, a subject can be identified as having a need for
treatment of a disorder (e.g., a disorder related to a dysfunction of histone
demethylase activity) based upon an earlier diagnosis by a person of skill and
thereafter subjected to treatment for the disorder. It is contemplated that the
identification can, in one aspect, be performed by a person different from the person
making the diagnosis. It is also contemplated, in a further aspect, that the
administration can be performed by one who subsequently performed the
administration.
As used herein, the terms ―administering‖ and ―administration‖ refer to
any method of providing a pharmaceutical preparation to a subject. Such methods
are well known to those skilled in the art and include, but are not limited to, oral
— 12 —
administration, transdermal administration, administration by inhalation, nasal
administration, topical administration, intravaginal administration, ophthalmic
administration, intraaural administration, intracerebral administration, rectal
administration, sublingual administration, buccal administration, intraurethral
administration, and parenteral administration, including injectable such as
intravenous administration, intra-arterial administration, intramuscular administration,
and subcutaneous administration. Administration can be continuous or intermittent.
In various aspects, a preparation can be administered therapeutically; that is,
administered to treat an existing disease or condition. In further various aspects, a
preparation can be administered prophylactically; that is, administered for prevention
of a disease or condition.
The term ―contacting‖ as used herein refers to bringing a disclosed
compound and a cell, target receptor, or other biological entity together in such a
manner that the compound can affect the activity of the target (e.g., receptor, cell,
etc.), either directly; i.e., by interacting with the target itself, or indirectly; i.e., by
interacting with another molecule, co-factor, factor, or protein on which the activity of
the target is dependent.
As used herein, the terms ―effective amount‖ and ―amount effective‖
refer to an amount that is sufficient to achieve the desired result or to have an effect
on an undesired condition. For example, a ―therapeutically effective amount‖ refers
to an amount that is sufficient to achieve the desired therapeutic result or to have an
effect on undesired symptoms, but is generally insufficient to cause adverse side
affects. The specific therapeutically effective dose level for any particular patient will
depend upon a variety of factors including the disorder being treated and the
severity of the disorder; the specific composition employed; the age, body weight,
general health, sex, and diet of the patient; the time of administration; the route of
administration; the rate of excretion of the specific compound employed; the duration
of the treatment; drugs used in combination or coincidental with the specific
compound employed and like factors well known in the medical arts. For example, it
is well within the skill of the art to start doses of a compound at levels lower than
those required to achieve the desired therapeutic effect and to gradually increase
the dosage until the desired effect is achieved. If desired, the effective daily dose
— 13 —
can be divided into multiple doses for purposes of administration. Consequently,
single dose compositions can contain such amounts or submultiples thereof to make
up the daily dose. The dosage can be adjusted by the individual physician in the
event of any contraindications. Dosage can vary, and can be administered in one or
more dose administrations daily, for one or several days. Guidance can be found in
the literature for appropriate dosages for given classes of pharmaceutical products.
In further various aspects, a preparation can be administered in a ―prophylactically
effective amount‖; that is, an amount effective for prevention of a disease or
condition.
As used herein, ―EC ,‖ is intended to refer to the concentration of a
substance (e.g., a compound or a drug) that is required for 50% agonism or
activation of a biological process, or component of a process, including a protein,
subunit, organelle, ribonucleoprotein, etc. In one aspect, an EC can refer to the
concentration of a substance that is required for 50% agonism or activation in vivo,
as further defined elsewhere herein. In a further aspect, EC refers to the
concentration of agonist or activator that provokes a response halfway between the
baseline and maximum response.
As used herein, ―IC ,‖ is intended to refer to the concentration of a
substance (e.g., a compound or a drug) that is required for 50% inhibition of a
biological process, or component of a process, including a protein, subunit,
organelle, ribonucleoprotein, etc. For example, an IC can refer to the
concentration of a substance that is required for 50% inhibition in vivo or the
inhibition is measured in vitro, as further defined elsewhere herein. Alternatively,
IC refers to the half maximal (50%) inhibitory concentration (IC) of a substance
The inhibition can be measured in a cell-line such as AN3 CA, BT-20, BT-549, HCT
116, HER218, MCF7, MDA-MB-231, MDA-MB-235, MDA-MB-435S, MDA-MB-468,
PANC-1, PC-3, SK-N-MC, T-47D, and U-87 MG. In a yet further aspect, the
inhibition is measured in a cell-line, e.g. HEK-293 or HeLa, transfected with a mutant
or wild-type mammalian histone demethylase, e.g. LSD1 or LSD2.
The term ―pharmaceutically acceptable‖ describes a material that is not
biologically or otherwise undesirable, i.e., without causing an unacceptable level of
undesirable biological effects or interacting in a deleterious manner.
— 14 —
The term ―stable,‖ as used herein, refers to compounds that are not
substantially altered when subjected to conditions to allow for their production,
detection, and, in certain aspects, their recovery, purification, and use for one or
more of the purposes disclosed herein.
As used herein, the term ―derivative‖ refers to a compound having a
structure derived from the structure of a parent compound (e.g., a compound
disclosed herein) and whose structure is sufficiently similar to those disclosed herein
and based upon that similarity, would be expected by one skilled in the art to exhibit
the same or similar activities and utilities as the claimed compounds, or to induce, as
a precursor, the same or similar activities and utilities as the claimed compounds.
Exemplary derivatives include salts, esters, amides, salts of esters or amides, and
N-oxides of a parent compound.
As used herein, the term ―pharmaceutically acceptable carrier‖ refers
to sterile aqueous or nonaqueous solutions, dispersions, suspensions or emulsions,
as well as sterile powders for reconstitution into sterile injectable solutions or
dispersions just prior to use. Examples of suitable aqueous and nonaqueous
carriers, diluents, solvents or vehicles include water, ethanol, polyols (such as
glycerol, propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol and the like), carboxymethylcellulose
and suitable mixtures thereof, vegetable oils (such as olive oil) and injectable
organic esters such as ethyl oleate. Proper fluidity can be maintained, for example,
by the use of coating materials such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required
particle size in the case of dispersions and by the use of surfactants. These
compositions can also contain adjuvants such as preservatives, wetting agents,
emulsifying agents and dispersing agents. Prevention of the action of
microorganisms can be ensured by the inclusion of various antibacterial and
antifungal agents such as paraben, chlorobutanol, phenol, sorbic acid and the like.
It can also be desirable to include isotonic agents such as sugars, sodium chloride
and the like. Prolonged absorption of the injectable pharmaceutical form can be
brought about by the inclusion of agents, such as aluminum monostearate and
gelatin, which delay absorption. Injectable depot forms are made by forming
microencapsule matrices of the drug in biodegradable polymers such as polylactide-
polyglycolide, poly(orthoesters) and poly(anhydrides). Depending upon the ratio of
— 15 —
drug to polymer and the nature of the particular polymer employed, the rate of drug
release can be controlled. Depot injectable formulations are also prepared by
entrapping the drug in liposomes or microemulsions which are compatible with body
tissues. The injectable formulations can be sterilized, for example, by filtration
through a bacterial-retaining filter or by incorporating sterilizing agents in the form of
sterile solid compositions which can be dissolved or dispersed in sterile water or
other sterile injectable media just prior to use. Suitable inert carriers can include
sugars such as lactose. Desirably, at least 95% by weight of the particles of the
active ingredient have an effective particle size in the range of 0.01 to 10
micrometers.
A residue of a chemical species, as used in the specification and
concluding claims, refers to the moiety that is the resulting product of the chemical
species in a particular reaction scheme or subsequent formulation or chemical
product, regardless of whether the moiety is actually obtained from the chemical
species. Thus, an ethylene glycol residue in a polyester refers to one or more -
OCH CH O- units in the polyester, regardless of whether ethylene glycol was used
to prepare the polyester. Similarly, a sebacic acid residue in a polyester refers to
one or more -CO(CH ) CO- moieties in the polyester, regardless of whether the
residue is obtained by reacting sebacic acid or an ester thereof to obtain the
polyester.
As used herein, the term ―substituted‖ is contemplated to include all
permissible substituents of organic compounds. In a broad aspect, the permissible
substituents include acyclic and cyclic, branched and unbranched, carbocyclic and
heterocyclic, and aromatic and nonaromatic substituents of organic compounds.
Illustrative substituents include, for example, those described below. The
permissible substituents can be one or more and the same or different for
appropriate organic compounds. For purposes of this disclosure, the heteroatoms,
such as nitrogen, can have hydrogen substituents and/or any permissible
substituents of organic compounds described herein which satisfy the valences of
the heteroatoms. This disclosure is not intended to be limited in any manner by the
permissible substituents of organic compounds. Also, the terms ―substitution‖ or
―substituted with‖ include the implicit proviso that such substitution is in accordance
— 16 —
with permitted valence of the substituted atom and the substituent, and that the
substitution results in a stable compound, e.g., a compound that does not
spontaneously undergo transformation such as by rearrangement, cyclization,
elimination, etc. It is also contemplated that, in certain aspects, unless expressly
indicated to the contrary, individual substituents can be further optionally substituted
(i.e., further substituted or unsubstituted).
1 2 3 4
In defining various terms, ―A ,‖ ―A ,‖ ―A ,‖ and ―A ‖ are used herein as
generic symbols to represent various specific substituents. These symbols can be
any substituent, not limited to those disclosed herein, and when they are defined to
be certain substituents in one instance, they can, in another instance, be defined as
some other substituents.
The term ―alkyl‖ as used herein is a branched or unbranched saturated
hydrocarbon group of 1 to 24 carbon atoms, such as methyl, ethyl, n-propyl,
isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, s-butyl, t-butyl, n-pentyl, isopentyl, s-pentyl, neopentyl,
hexyl, heptyl, octyl, nonyl, decyl, dodecyl, tetradecyl, hexadecyl, eicosyl, tetracosyl,
and the like. The alkyl group can be cyclic or acyclic. The alkyl group can be
branched or unbranched. The alkyl group can also be substituted or unsubstituted.
For example, the alkyl group can be substituted with one or more groups including,
but not limited to, alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkoxy, amino, ether, halide, hydroxy, nitro, silyl,
sulfo-oxo, or thiol, as described herein. A ―lower alkyl‖ group is an alkyl group
containing from one to six (e.g., from one to four) carbon atoms.
For example, a ―C1-C3 alkyl‖ group can be selected from methyl, ethyl,
n-propyl, i-propyl, and cyclopropyl, or from a subset thereof. In certain aspects, the
―C1-C3 alkyl‖ group can be optionally further substituted. As a further example, a
―C1-C4 alkyl‖ group can be selected from methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, i-propyl,
cyclopropyl, n-butyl, i-butyl, s-butyl, t-butyl, and cyclobutyl, or from a subset thereof.
In certain aspects, the ―C1-C4 alkyl‖ group can be optionally further substituted. As
a further example, a ―C1-C6 alkyl‖ group can be selected from methyl, ethyl, n-
propyl, i-propyl, cyclopropyl, n-butyl, i-butyl, s-butyl, t-butyl, cyclobutyl, n-pentyl, i-
pentyl, s-pentyl, t-pentyl, neopentyl, cyclopentyl, n-hexyl, i-hexyl, 3-methylpentane,
2,3-dimethylbutane, neohexane, and cyclohexane, or from a subset thereof. In
certain aspects, the ―C1-C6 alkyl‖ group can be optionally further substituted. As a
— 17 —
further example, a ―C1-C8 alkyl‖ group can be selected from methyl, ethyl, n-propyl,
i-propyl, cyclopropyl, n-butyl, i-butyl, s-butyl, t-butyl, cyclobutyl, n-pentyl, i-pentyl, s-
pentyl, t-pentyl, neopentyl, cyclopentyl, n-hexyl, i-hexyl, 3-methylpentane, 2,3-
dimethylbutane, neohexane, cyclohexane, heptane, cycloheptane, octane, and
cyclooctane, or from a subset thereof. In certain aspects, the ―C1-C8 alkyl‖ group
can be optionally further substituted. As a further example, a ―C1-C12 alkyl‖ group
can be selected from methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, i-propyl, cyclopropyl, n-butyl, i-butyl, s-
butyl, t-butyl, cyclobutyl, n-pentyl, i-pentyl, s-pentyl, t-pentyl, neopentyl, cyclopentyl,
n-hexyl, i-hexyl, 3-methylpentane, 2,3-dimethylbutane, neohexane, cyclohexane,
heptane, cycloheptane, octane, cyclooctane, nonane, cyclononane, decane,
cyclodecane, undecane, cycloundecane, dodecane, and cyclododecane, or from a
subset thereof. In certain aspects, the ―C1-C12 alkyl‖ group can be optionally further
substituted.
Throughout the specification ―alkyl‖ is generally used to refer to both
unsubstituted alkyl groups and substituted alkyl groups; however, substituted alkyl
groups are also specifically referred to herein by identifying the specific
substituent(s) on the alkyl group. For example, the term ―halogenated alkyl‖ or
―haloalkyl‖ specifically refers to an alkyl group that is substituted with one or more
halide, e.g., fluorine, chlorine, bromine, or iodine. The term ―alkoxyalkyl‖ specifically
refers to an alkyl group that is substituted with one or more alkoxy groups, as
described below. The term ―alkylamino‖ specifically refers to an alkyl group that is
substituted with one or more amino groups, as described below, and the like. When
―alkyl‖ is used in one instance and a specific term such as ―alkylalcohol‖ is used in
another, it is not meant to imply that the term ―alkyl‖ does not also refer to specific
terms such as ―alkylalcohol‖ and the like.
This practice is also used for other groups described herein. That is,
while a term such as ―cycloalkyl‖ refers to both unsubstituted and substituted
cycloalkyl moieties, the substituted moieties can, in addition, be specifically identified
herein; for example, a particular substituted cycloalkyl can be referred to as, e.g., an
―alkylcycloalkyl.‖ Similarly, a substituted alkoxy can be specifically referred to as,
e.g., a ―halogenated alkoxy,‖ a particular substituted alkenyl can be, e.g., an
―alkenylalcohol,‖ and the like. Again, the practice of using a general term, such as
— 18 —
―cycloalkyl,‖ and a specific term, such as ―alkylcycloalkyl,‖ is not meant to imply that
the general term does not also include the specific term.
The term ―cycloalkyl‖ as used herein is a non-aromatic carbon-based
ring composed of at least three carbon atoms. Examples of cycloalkyl groups
include, but are not limited to, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl,
norbornyl, and the like. The term ―heterocycloalkyl‖ is a type of cycloalkyl group as
defined above, and is included within the meaning of the term ―cycloalkyl,‖ where at
least one of the carbon atoms of the ring is replaced with a heteroatom such as, but
not limited to, nitrogen, oxygen, sulfur, or phosphorus. The cycloalkyl group and
heterocycloalkyl group can be substituted or unsubstituted. The cycloalkyl group
and heterocycloalkyl group can be substituted with one or more groups including,
but not limited to, alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkoxy, amino, ether, halide, hydroxy, nitro, silyl,
sulfo-oxo, nitrile, sulfonamide, or thiol as described herein.
The term ―polyalkylene group‖ as used herein is a group having two or
more CH groups linked to one another. The polyalkylene group can be represented
by the formula —(CH ) —, where ―a‖ is an integer of from 2 to 500.
The terms ―alkoxy‖ and ―alkoxyl‖ as used herein to refer to an alkyl or
cycloalkyl group bonded through an ether linkage; that is, an ―alkoxy‖ group can be
defined as —OA where A is alkyl or cycloalkyl as defined above. ―Alkoxy‖ also
includes polymers of alkoxy groups as just described; that is, an alkoxy can be a
1 2 1 2 3
polyether such as —OA —OA or —OA —(OA ) —OA , where ―a‖ is an integer of
1 2 3
from 1 to 200 and A , A , and A are alkyl and/or cycloalkyl groups.
The term ―alkenyl‖ as used herein is a hydrocarbon group of from 2 to
24 carbon atoms with a structural formula containing at least one carbon-carbon
1 2 3 4
double bond. Asymmetric structures such as (A A )C=C(A A ) are intended to
include both the E and Z isomers. This can be presumed in structural formulae
herein wherein an asymmetric alkene is present, or it can be explicitly indicated by
the bond symbol C=C. The alkenyl group can be substituted with one or more
groups including, but not limited to, alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkoxy, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl,
alkynyl, cycloalkynyl, aryl, heteroaryl, aldehyde, amino, carboxylic acid, ester, ether,
— 19 —
halide, hydroxy, ketone, azide, nitro, silyl, sulfo-oxo, nitrile, sulfonamide, or thiol, as
described herein.
The term ―cycloalkenyl‖ as used herein is a non-aromatic carbon-based
ring composed of at least three carbon atoms and containing at least one carbon-
carbon double bound, i.e., C=C. Examples of cycloalkenyl groups include, but are
not limited to, cyclopropenyl, cyclobutenyl, cyclopentenyl, cyclopentadienyl,
cyclohexenyl, cyclohexadienyl, norbornenyl, and the like. The term
―heterocycloalkenyl‖ is a type of cycloalkenyl group as defined above, and is
included within the meaning of the term ―cycloalkenyl,‖ where at least one of the
carbon atoms of the ring is replaced with a heteroatom such as, but not limited to,
nitrogen, oxygen, sulfur, or phosphorus. The cycloalkenyl group and
heterocycloalkenyl group can be substituted or unsubstituted. The cycloalkenyl
group and heterocycloalkenyl group can be substituted with one or more groups
including, but not limited to, alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkoxy, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl, alkynyl,
cycloalkynyl, aryl, heteroaryl, aldehyde, amino, carboxylic acid, ester, ether, halide,
hydroxy, ketone, azide, nitro, silyl, sulfo-oxo, nitrile, sulfonamide, or thiol as
described herein.
The term ―alkynyl‖ as used herein is a hydrocarbon group of 2 to 24
carbon atoms with a structural formula containing at least one carbon-carbon triple
bond. The alkynyl group can be unsubstituted or substituted with one or more
groups including, but not limited to, alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkoxy, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl,
alkynyl, cycloalkynyl, aryl, heteroaryl, aldehyde, amino, carboxylic acid, ester, ether,
halide, hydroxy, ketone, azide, nitro, silyl, sulfo-oxo, nitrile, sulfonamide, or thiol, as
described herein.
The term ―cycloalkynyl‖ as used herein is a non-aromatic carbon-based
ring composed of at least seven carbon atoms and containing at least one carbon-
carbon triple bound. Examples of cycloalkynyl groups include, but are not limited to,
cycloheptynyl, cyclooctynyl, cyclononynyl, and the like. The term
―heterocycloalkynyl‖ is a type of cycloalkenyl group as defined above, and is
included within the meaning of the term ―cycloalkynyl,‖ where at least one of the
carbon atoms of the ring is replaced with a heteroatom such as, but not limited to,
nitrogen, oxygen, sulfur, or phosphorus. The cycloalkynyl group and
— 20 —
heterocycloalkynyl group can be substituted or unsubstituted. The cycloalkynyl
group and heterocycloalkynyl group can be substituted with one or more groups
including, but not limited to, alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkoxy, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl, alkynyl,
cycloalkynyl, aryl, heteroaryl, aldehyde, amino, carboxylic acid, ester, ether, halide,
hydroxy, ketone, azide, nitro, silyl, sulfo-oxo, nitrile, sulfonamide, or thiol as
described herein.
The term ―aryl‖ as used herein is a group that contains any carbon-
based aromatic group including, but not limited to, benzene, naphthalene, phenyl,
biphenyl, phenoxybenzene, and the like. The term ―aryl‖ also includes ―heteroaryl,‖
which is defined as a group that contains an aromatic group that has at least one
heteroatom incorporated within the ring of the aromatic group. Examples of
heteroatoms include, but are not limited to, nitrogen, oxygen, sulfur, and
phosphorus. Likewise, the term ―non-heteroaryl,‖ which is also included in the term
―aryl,‖ defines a group that contains an aromatic group that does not contain a
heteroatom. The aryl group can be substituted or unsubstituted. The aryl group can
be substituted with one or more groups including, but not limited to, alkyl, cycloalkyl,
alkoxy, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkynyl, aryl, heteroaryl, aldehyde, amino,
carboxylic acid, ester, ether, halide, hydroxy, ketone, azide, nitro, silyl, sulfo-oxo,
nitrile, sulfonamide, or thiol as described herein. The term ―biaryl‖ is a specific type
of aryl group and is included in the definition of ―aryl.‖ Biaryl refers to two aryl groups
that are bound together via a fused ring structure, as in naphthalene, or are attached
via one or more carbon-carbon bonds, as in biphenyl.
The term ―aldehyde‖ as used herein is represented by the formula —
C(O)H. Throughout this specification ―C(O)‖ is a short hand notation for a carbonyl
group, i.e., C=O.
The terms ―amine‖ or ―amino‖ as used herein are represented by the
1 2 1 2
formula —NA A , where A and A can be, independently, hydrogen or alkyl,
cycloalkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkynyl, aryl, or heteroaryl group as
described herein.
The term ―alkylamino‖ as used herein is represented by the formula —
NH(-alkyl) where alkyl is a described herein. Representative examples include, but
— 21 —
are not limited to, methylamino group, ethylamino group, propylamino group,
isopropylamino group, butylamino group, isobutylamino group, (sec-butyl)amino
group, (tert-butyl)amino group, pentylamino group, isopentylamino group, (tert-
pentyl)amino group, hexylamino group, and the like.
The term ―dialkylamino‖ as used herein is represented by the formula
—N(-alkyl) where alkyl is a described herein. Representative examples include, but
are not limited to, dimethylamino group, diethylamino group, dipropylamino group,
diisopropylamino group, dibutylamino group, diisobutylamino group, di(sec-
butyl)amino group, di(tert-butyl)amino group, dipentylamino group, diisopentylamino
group, di(tert-pentyl)amino group, dihexylamino group, N-ethyl-N-methylamino
group, N-methyl-N-propylamino group, N-ethyl-N-propylamino group and the like.
The term ―carboxylic acid‖ as used herein is represented by the
formula —C(O)OH.
The term ―ester‖ as used herein is represented by the formula —
1 1 1
OC(O)A or —C(O)OA , where A can be alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl,
alkynyl, cycloalkynyl, aryl, or heteroaryl group as described herein. The term
―polyester‖ as used herein is represented by the formula —(A O(O)C-A -C(O)O) —
1 2 1 2
or —(A O(O)C-A -OC(O)) —, where A and A can be, independently, an alkyl,
cycloalkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkynyl, aryl, or heteroaryl group
described herein and ―a‖ is an interger from 1 to 500. ―Polyester‖ is as the term used
to describe a group that is produced by the reaction between a compound having at
least two carboxylic acid groups with a compound having at least two hydroxyl
groups.
The term ―ether‖ as used herein is represented by the formula A OA ,
where A and A can be, independently, an alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl,
alkynyl, cycloalkynyl, aryl, or heteroaryl group described herein. The term
1 2 1
―polyether‖ as used herein is represented by the formula —(A O-A O) —, where A
and A can be, independently, an alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl, alkynyl,
cycloalkynyl, aryl, or heteroaryl group described herein and ―a‖ is an integer of from
1 to 500. Examples of polyether groups include polyethylene oxide, polypropylene
oxide, and polybutylene oxide.
— 22 —
The terms ―halogen,‖ ―halide,‖ and ―halo,‖ as used herein, refer to the
halogens fluorine, chlorine, bromine, and iodine. It is also contemplated that, in
various aspects, halogen can be selected from fluoro, chloro, bromo, and iodo. For
example, halogen can be selected from fluoro, chloro, and bromo. As a further
example, halogen can be selected from fluoro and chloro. As a further example,
halogen can be selected from chloro and bromo. As a further example, halogen can
be selected from bromo and iodo. As a further example, halogen can be selected
from chloro, bromo, and iodo. In one aspect, halogen can be fluoro. In a further
aspect, halogen can be chloro. In a still further aspect, halogen is bromo. In a yet
further aspect, halogen is iodo.
It is also contemplated that, in certain aspects, pseudohalogens (e.g.
triflate, mesylate, tosylate, brosylate, etc.) can be used in place of halogens. For
example, in certain aspects, halogen can be replaced by pseudohalogen. As a
further example, pseudohalogen can be selected from triflate, mesylate, tosylate,
and brosylate. In one aspect, pseudohalogen is triflate. In a further aspect,
pseudohalogen is mesylate. In a further aspect, pseudohalogen is tosylate. In a
further aspect, pseudohalogen is brosylate.
The term ―heterocycle,‖ as used herein refers to single and multi-cyclic
aromatic or non-aromatic ring systems in which at least one of the ring members is
other than carbon. Heterocycle includes azetidine, dioxane, furan, imidazole,
isothiazole, isoxazole, morpholine, oxazole, oxazole, including, 1,2,3-oxadiazole,
1,2,5-oxadiazole and 1,3,4-oxadiazole, piperazine, piperidine, pyrazine, pyrazole,
pyridazine, pyridine, pyrimidine, pyrrole, pyrrolidine, tetrahydrofuran,
tetrahydropyran, tetrazine, including 1,2,4,5-tetrazine, tetrazole, including 1,2,3,4-
tetrazole and 1,2,4,5-tetrazole, thiadiazole, including, 1,2,3-thiadiazole, 1,2,5-
thiadiazole, and 1,3,4-thiadiazole, thiazole, thiophene, triazine, including 1,3,5-
triazine and 1,2,4-triazine, triazole, including, 1,2,3-triazole, 1,3,4-triazole, and the
like.
The term ―hydroxyl‖ as used herein is represented by the formula —
— 23 —
The term ―ketone‖ as used herein is represented by the formula
1 2 1 2
A C(O)A , where A and A can be, independently, an alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkenyl,
cycloalkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkynyl, aryl, or heteroaryl group as described herein.
The term ―azide‖ as used herein is represented by the formula —N .
The term ―nitro‖ as used herein is represented by the formula —NO .
The term ―nitrile‖ as used herein is represented by the formula —CN.
The term ―silyl‖ as used herein is represented by the formula —
1 2 3 1 2 3
SiA A A , where A , A , and A can be, independently, hydrogen or an alkyl,
cycloalkyl, alkoxy, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkynyl, aryl, or heteroaryl
group as described herein.
The term ―sulfo-oxo‖ as used herein is represented by the formulas —
1 1 1 1 1
S(O)A , —S(O) A , —OS(O) A , or —OS(O) OA , where A can be hydrogen or an
2 2 2
alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkynyl, aryl, or heteroaryl group
as described herein. Throughout this specification ―S(O)‖ is a short hand notation
for S=O. The term ―sulfonyl‖ is used herein to refer to the sulfo-oxo group
represented by the formula —S(O) A , where A can be hydrogen or an alkyl,
cycloalkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkynyl, aryl, or heteroaryl group as
described herein. The term ―sulfone‖ as used herein is represented by the formula
1 2 1 2
A S(O) A , where A and A can be, independently, an alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkenyl,
cycloalkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkynyl, aryl, or heteroaryl group as described herein.
The term ―sulfoxide‖ as used herein is represented by the formula A S(O)A , where
A and A can be, independently, an alkyl, cycloalkyl, alkenyl, cycloalkenyl, alkynyl,
cycloalkynyl, aryl, or heteroaryl group as described herein.
The term ―thiol‖ as used herein is represented by the formula —SH.
1 2 3 n
―R ,‖ ―R ,‖ ―R ,‖ ―R ,‖ where n is an integer, as used herein can,
independently, possess one or more of the groups listed above. For example, if R
is a straight chain alkyl group, one of the hydrogen atoms of the alkyl group can
optionally be substituted with a hydroxyl group, an alkoxy group, an alkyl group, a
halide, and the like. Depending upon the groups that are selected, a first group can
— 24 —
be incorporated within second group or, alternatively, the first group can be pendant
(i.e., attached) to the second group. For example, with the phrase ―an alkyl group
comprising an amino group,‖ the amino group can be incorporated within the
backbone of the alkyl group. Alternatively, the amino group can be attached to the
backbone of the alkyl group. The nature of the group(s) that is (are) selected will
determine if the first group is embedded or attached to the second group.
As described herein, compounds of the invention may contain
―optionally substituted‖ moieties. In general, the term ―substituted,‖ whether
preceded by the term ―optionally‖ or not, means that one or more hydrogens of the
designated moiety are replaced with a suitable substituent. Unless otherwise
indicated, an ―optionally substituted‖ group may have a suitable substituent at each
substitutable position of the group, and when more than one position in any given
structure may be substituted with more than one substituent selected from a
specified group, the substituent may be either the same or different at every
position. Combinations of substituents envisioned by this invention are preferably
those that result in the formation of stable or chemically feasible compounds. In is
also contemplated that, in certain aspects, unless expressly indicated to the
contrary, individual substituents can be further optionally substituted (i.e., further
substituted or unsubstituted).
Suitable monovalent substituents on a substitutable carbon atom of an
―optionally substituted‖ group are independently halogen; –(CH ) R ; –(CH )
2 0–4 2 0–
OR ; -O(CH ) R , –O–(CH ) C(O)OR°; –(CH ) CH(OR ) ; –(CH ) SR ; –
4 2 0-4 2 0–4 2 0–4 2 2 0–4
(CH ) Ph, which may be substituted with R°; –(CH ) O(CH ) Ph which may be
2 0–4 2 0–4 2 0–1
substituted with R°; –CH=CHPh, which may be substituted with R°; –(CH )
2 0–
O(CH ) -pyridyl which may be substituted with R°; –NO ; –CN; –N ; -(CH )
4 2 0–1 2 3 2 0–
N(R ) ; –(CH ) N(R )C(O)R ; –N(R )C(S)R ; –(CH )
4 2 2 0–4 2 0–
N(R )C(O)NR ; -N(R )C(S)NR ; –(CH ) N(R )C(O)OR ; –
4 2 2 2 0–4
N(R )N(R )C(O)R ; -N(R )N(R )C(O)NR ; -N(R )N(R )C(O)OR ; –(CH ) C(O)R ; –
2 2 0–4
C(S)R ; –(CH ) C(O)OR ; –(CH ) C(O)SR ; -(CH ) C(O)OSiR ; –(CH )
2 0–4 2 0–4 2 0–4 3 2 0–
OC(O)R ; –OC(O)(CH ) SR–, SC(S)SR°; –(CH ) SC(O)R ; –(CH ) C(O)NR ;
4 2 0–4 2 0–4 2 0–4 2
–C(S)NR ; –C(S)SR°; –SC(S)SR°, -(CH ) OC(O)NR ; -C(O)N(OR )R ; –
2 2 0–4 2
C(O)C(O)R ; –C(O)CH C(O)R ; –C(NOR )R ; -(CH ) SSR ; –(CH ) S(O) R ; –
2 2 0–4 2 0–4 2
— 25 —
(CH ) S(O) OR ; –(CH ) OS(O) R ; –S(O) NR ; -(CH )
2 0–4 2 2 0–4 2 2 2 2 0–
S(O)R ; -N(R )S(O) NR ; –N(R )S(O) R ; –N(OR)R ; –C(NH)NR ; –
4 2 2 2 2
P(O) R ; -P(O)R ; -OP(O)R ; –OP(O)(OR ) ; SiR ; –(C straight or branched
2 2 2 2 3 1–4
alkylene)O–N(R ) ; or –(C straight or branched alkylene)C(O)O–N(R ) , wherein
2 1–4 2
each R may be substituted as defined below and is independently hydrogen, C
aliphatic, –CH Ph, –O(CH ) Ph, -CH -(5-6 membered heteroaryl ring), or a 5–6–
6 2 2 0–1 2
membered saturated, partially unsaturated, or aryl ring having 0–4 heteroatoms
independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, or, notwithstanding the
definition above, two independent occurrences of R , taken together with their
intervening atom(s), form a 3–12–membered saturated, partially unsaturated, or aryl
mono– or bicyclic ring having 0–4 heteroatoms independently selected from
nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, which may be substituted as defined below.
Suitable monovalent substituents on R (or the ring formed by taking
two independent occurrences of R together with their intervening atoms), are
independently halogen, –(CH ) R , –(haloR ), –(CH ) OH, –(CH ) OR , –
2 0–2 2 0–2 2 0–2
(CH ) CH(OR ) ; -O(haloR ), –CN, –N , –(CH ) C(O)R , –(CH ) C(O)OH, –
2 0–2 2 3 2 0–2 2 0–2
(CH ) C(O)OR , –(CH ) SR , –(CH ) SH, –(CH ) NH , –(CH ) NHR , –
2 0–2 2 0–2 2 0–2 2 0–2 2 2 0–2
(CH ) NR , –NO , –SiR , –OSiR , -C(O)SR –(C straight or branched
2 0–2 2 2 3 3 , 1–4
alkylene)C(O)OR , or –SSR wherein each R is unsubstituted or where preceded
by ―halo‖ is substituted only with one or more halogens, and is independently
selected from C aliphatic, –CH Ph, –O(CH ) Ph, or a 5–6–membered saturated,
1–4 2 2 0–1
partially unsaturated, or aryl ring having 0–4 heteroatoms independently selected
from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur. Suitable divalent substituents on a saturated
carbon atom of R include =O and =S.
Suitable divalent substituents on a saturated carbon atom of an
―optionally substituted‖ group include the following: =O, =S, =NNR , =NNHC(O)R ,
* * * * * *
=NNHC(O)OR , =NNHS(O) R , =NR , =NOR , –O(C(R )) O–, or –S(C(R )) S–,
2 2 2–3 2 2–3
wherein each independent occurrence of R is selected from hydrogen, C aliphatic
which may be substituted as defined below, or an unsubstituted 5–6–membered
saturated, partially unsaturated, or aryl ring having 0–4 heteroatoms independently
selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur. Suitable divalent substituents that are
bound to vicinal substitutable carbons of an ―optionally substituted‖ group include: –
— 26 —
O(CR ) O–, wherein each independent occurrence of R is selected from
2 2–3
hydrogen, C aliphatic which may be substituted as defined below, or an
unsubstituted 5–6–membered saturated, partially unsaturated, or aryl ring having 0–
4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur.
Suitable substituents on the aliphatic group of R include halogen, –
R , -(haloR ), -OH, –OR , –O(haloR ), –CN, –C(O)OH, –C(O)OR , –NH , –NHR , –
NR , or –NO , wherein each R is unsubstituted or where preceded by ―halo‖ is
substituted only with one or more halogens, and is independently C aliphatic, –
CH Ph, –O(CH ) Ph, or a 5–6–membered saturated, partially unsaturated, or aryl
2 2 0–1
ring having 0–4 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or
sulfur.
Suitable substituents on a substitutable nitrogen of an ―optionally
† † † † †
substituted‖ group include –R , –NR , –C(O)R , –C(O)OR , –C(O)C(O)R , –
† † † † † † †
C(O)CH C(O)R , –S(O) R , -S(O) NR , –C(S)NR , –C(NH)NR , or –N(R )S(O) R ;
2 2 2 2 2 2 2
wherein each R is independently hydrogen, C aliphatic which may be substituted
as defined below, unsubstituted –OPh, or an unsubstituted 5–6–membered
saturated, partially unsaturated, or aryl ring having 0–4 heteroatoms independently
selected from nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur, or, notwithstanding the definition above,
two independent occurrences of R , taken together with their intervening atom(s)
form an unsubstituted 3–12–membered saturated, partially unsaturated, or aryl
mono– or bicyclic ring having 0–4 heteroatoms independently selected from
nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur.
Suitable substituents on the aliphatic group of R are independently
halogen, –R , -(haloR ), –OH, –OR , –O(haloR ), –CN, –C(O)OH, –C(O)OR , –NH ,
–NHR , –NR , or -NO , wherein each R is unsubstituted or where preceded by
―halo‖ is substituted only with one or more halogens, and is independently C
aliphatic, –CH Ph, –O(CH ) Ph, or a 5–6–membered saturated, partially
4 2 2 0–1
unsaturated, or aryl ring having 0–4 heteroatoms independently selected from
nitrogen, oxygen, or sulfur.
The term ―leaving group‖ refers to an atom (or a group of atoms) with
electron withdrawing ability that can be displaced as a stable species, taking with it
— 27 —
the bonding electrons. Examples of suitable leaving groups include halides –
including chloro, bromo, and iodo – and pseudohalides (sulfonate esters) – including
triflate, mesylate, tosylate, and brosylate. It is alos contemplated that a hydroxyl
moiety can be converted into a leaving group via Mitsunobu reaction.
The terms ―hydrolysable group‖ and ―hydrolysable moiety‖ refer to a
functional group capable of undergoing hydrolysis, e.g., under basic or acidic
conditions. Examples of hydrolysable residues include, without limitatation, acid
halides, activated carboxylic acids, and various protecting groups known in the art
(see, for example, Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis, T. W. Greene, P. G. M.
Wuts, Wiley-Interscience, 1999).
The term ―protecting group‖ means a group which protects one or more
functional groups of a compound giving rise to a protected derivative of the specified
compound. Functional groups which may be protected include, by way of example,
amino groups, hydroxyl groups, and the like. Protecting groups are well-known to
those skilled in the art and are described, for example, in T. W. Greene and G. M.
Wuts, Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis, Third Edition, Wiley, New York, 1999,
and references cited therein.
The term ―amino-protecting group‖ means a protecting group suitable
for preventing undesired reactions at an amino group, include, but are not limited to,
tert-butoxycarbonyl (BOC), trityl (Tr), benzyloxycarbonyl (Cbz), 9-
fluorenylmethoxycarbonyl (FMOC), formyl, trimethylsilyl (TMS), tert-butyldimethylsilyl
(TBS), benzyl, p-methoxybenzyl, p-fluorobenzyl, p-chlorobenzyl, p-bromobenzyl,
diphenylmethyl naphtylmethyl, tetrahydropyran (THP), and the like.
The term ―hydroxyl-protecting group‖ means a protecting group
suitable for preventing undesirable reactions at a hydroxyl group. Representative
hydroxyl-protecting groups include, but are not limited to, silyl groups including tri(1-
6C)-alkylsilyl groups, such as trimethylsilyl (TMS), triethylsilyl (TES), tert-
butyldimethylsilyl (TBS), and the like; esters (acyl groups) including (1-6C)-alkanoyl
groups, such as formyl, acetyl, and the like; arylmethyl groups, such as benzyl (Bn),
p-methoxybenzyl (PMB), 9-fluorenylmethyl (Fm), diphenylmethyl (benzhydryl, DPM),
— 28 —
tetrahydropyran (THP), methoxylmethyl (MOM), methylthiomethyl (MTM),
benzyloxymethyl (BOM), and the like.
The term ―organic residue‖ defines a carbon containing residue, i.e., a
residue comprising at least one carbon atom, and includes but is not limited to the
carbon-containing groups, residues, or radicals defined hereinabove. Organic
residues can contain various heteroatoms, or be bonded to another molecule
through a heteroatom, including oxygen, nitrogen, sulfur, phosphorus, or the like.
Examples of organic residues include but are not limited alkyl or substituted alkyls,
alkoxy or substituted alkoxy, mono or di-substituted amino, amide groups, etc.
Organic residues can preferably comprise 1 to 18 carbon atoms, 1 to 15, carbon
atoms, 1 to 12 carbon atoms, 1 to 8 carbon atoms, 1 to 6 carbon atoms, or 1 to 4
carbon atoms. In a further aspect, an organic residue can comprise 2 to 18 carbon
atoms, 2 to 15, carbon atoms, 2 to 12 carbon atoms, 2 to 8 carbon atoms, 2 to 4
carbon atoms, or 2 to 4 carbon atoms.
A very close synonym of the term ―residue‖ is the term ―radical,‖ which
as used in the specification and concluding claims, refers to a fragment, group, or
substructure of a molecule described herein, regardless of how the molecule is
prepared. For example, a 2,4-thiazolidinedione radical in a particular compound has
the structure:
regardless of whether thiazolidinedione is used to prepare the
compound. In some embodiments the radical (for example an alkyl) can be further
modified (i.e., substituted alkyl) by having bonded thereto one or more ―substituent
radicals.‖ The number of atoms in a given radical is not critical to the present
invention unless it is indicated to the contrary elsewhere herein.
―Organic radicals,‖ as the term is defined and used herein, contain one
or more carbon atoms. An organic radical can have, for example, 1-26 carbon
atoms, 1-18 carbon atoms, 1-12 carbon atoms, 1-8 carbon atoms, 1-6 carbon
— 29 —
atoms, or 1-4 carbon atoms. In a further aspect, an organic radical can have 2-26
carbon atoms, 2-18 carbon atoms, 2-12 carbon atoms, 2-8 carbon atoms, 2-6
carbon atoms, or 2-4 carbon atoms. Organic radicals often have hydrogen bound to
at least some of the carbon atoms of the organic radical. One example, of an
organic radical that comprises no inorganic atoms is a 5, 6, 7, 8-tetrahydro
naphthyl radical. In some embodiments, an organic radical can contain 1-10
inorganic heteroatoms bound thereto or therein, including halogens, oxygen, sulfur,
nitrogen, phosphorus, and the like. Examples of organic radicals include but are not
limited to an alkyl, substituted alkyl, cycloalkyl, substituted cycloalkyl, mono-
substituted amino, di-substituted amino, acyloxy, cyano, carboxy, carboalkoxy,
alkylcarboxamide, substituted alkylcarboxamide, dialkylcarboxamide, substituted
dialkylcarboxamide, alkylsulfonyl, alkylsulfinyl, thioalkyl, thiohaloalkyl, alkoxy,
substituted alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, aryl, substituted aryl, heteroaryl,
heterocyclic, or substituted heterocyclic radicals, wherein the terms are defined
elsewhere herein. A few non-limiting examples of organic radicals that include
heteroatoms include alkoxy radicals, trifluoromethoxy radicals, acetoxy radicals,
dimethylamino radicals and the like.
―Inorganic radicals,‖ as the term is defined and used herein, contain
no carbon atoms and therefore comprise only atoms other than carbon. Inorganic
radicals comprise bonded combinations of atoms selected from hydrogen, nitrogen,
oxygen, silicon, phosphorus, sulfur, selenium, and halogens such as fluorine,
chlorine, bromine, and iodine, which can be present individually or bonded together
in their chemically stable combinations. Inorganic radicals have 10 or fewer, or
preferably one to six or one to four inorganic atoms as listed above bonded together.
Examples of inorganic radicals include, but not limited to, amino, hydroxy, halogens,
nitro, thiol, sulfate, phosphate, and like commonly known inorganic radicals. The
inorganic radicals do not have bonded therein the metallic elements of the periodic
table (such as the alkali metals, alkaline earth metals, transition metals, lanthanide
metals, or actinide metals), although such metal ions can sometimes serve as a
pharmaceutically acceptable cation for anionic inorganic radicals such as a sulfate,
phosphate, or like anionic inorganic radical. Inorganic radicals do not comprise
metalloids elements such as boron, aluminum, gallium, germanium, arsenic, tin,
— 30 —
lead, or tellurium, or the noble gas elements, unless otherwise specifically indicated
elsewhere herein.
Compounds described herein can contain one or more double bonds
and, thus, potentially give rise to cis/trans (E/Z) isomers, as well as other
conformational isomers. Unless stated to the contrary, the invention includes all
such possible isomers, as well as mixtures of such isomers.
Unless stated to the contrary, a formula with chemical bonds shown
only as solid lines and not as wedges or dashed lines contemplates each possible
isomer, e.g., each enantiomer and diastereomer, and a mixture of isomers, such as
a racemic or scalemic mixture. Compounds described herein can contain one or
more asymmetric centers and, thus, potentially give rise to diastereomers and
optical isomers. Unless stated to the contrary, the present invention includes all
such possible diastereomers as well as their racemic mixtures, their substantially
pure resolved enantiomers, all possible geometric isomers, and pharmaceutically
acceptable salts thereof. Mixtures of stereoisomers, as well as isolated specific
stereoisomers, are also included. During the course of the synthetic procedures
used to prepare such compounds, or in using racemization or epimerization
procedures known to those skilled in the art, the products of such procedures can be
a mixture of stereoisomers.
Many organic compounds exist in optically active forms having the
ability to rotate the plane of plane-polarized light. In describing an optically active
compound, the prefixes D and L or R and S are used to denote the absolute
configuration of the molecule about its chiral center(s). The prefixes d and l or (+)
and (-) are employed to designate the sign of rotation of plane-polarized light by the
compound, with (-) or l meaning that the compound is levorotatory. A compound
prefixed with (+) or d is dextrorotatory. For a given chemical structure, these
compounds, called stereoisomers, are identical except that they are non-
superimposable mirror images of one another. A specific stereoisomer can also be
referred to as an enantiomer, and a mixture of such isomers is often called an
enantiomeric mixture. A 50:50 mixture of enantiomers is referred to as a racemic
mixture. Many of the compounds described herein can have one or more chiral
centers and therefore can exist in different enantiomeric forms. If desired, a chiral
— 31 —
carbon can be designated with an asterisk (*). When bonds to the chiral carbon are
depicted as straight lines in the disclosed formulas, it is understood that both the (R)
and (S) configurations of the chiral carbon, and hence both enantiomers and
mixtures thereof, are embraced within the formula. As is used in the art, when it is
desired to specify the absolute configuration about a chiral carbon, one of the bonds
to the chiral carbon can be depicted as a wedge (bonds to atoms above the plane)
and the other can be depicted as a series or wedge of short parallel lines is (bonds
to atoms below the plane). The Cahn-Inglod-Prelog system can be used to assign
the (R) or (S) configuration to a chiral carbon.
Compounds described herein comprise atoms in both their natural
isotopic abundance and in non-natural abundance. The disclosed compounds can
be isotopically-labelled or isotopically-substituted compounds identical to those
described, but for the fact that one or more atoms are replaced by an atom having
an atomic mass or mass number different from the atomic mass or mass number
typically found in nature. Examples of isotopes that can be incorporated into
compounds of the invention include isotopes of hydrogen, carbon, nitrogen, oxygen,
2 3 13 14 15 18 17 35
phosphorous, fluorine and chlorine, such as H, H, C, C, N, O, O, S,
18 36
F and Cl, respectively. Compounds further comprise prodrugs thereof, and
pharmaceutically acceptable salts of said compounds or of said prodrugs which
contain the aforementioned isotopes and/or other isotopes of other atoms are within
the scope of this invention. Certain isotopically-labelled compounds of the present
3 14
invention, for example those into which radioactive isotopes such as H and C are
incorporated, are useful in drug and/or substrate tissue distribution assays. Tritiated,
3 14
i.e., H, and carbon-14, i.e., C, isotopes are particularly preferred for their ease of
preparation and detectability. Further, substitution with heavier isotopes such as
deuterium, i.e., H, can afford certain therapeutic advantages resulting from greater
metabolic stability, for example increased in vivo half-life or reduced dosage
requirements and, hence, may be preferred in some circumstances. Isotopically
labelled compounds of the present invention and prodrugs thereof can generally be
prepared by carrying out the procedures below, by substituting a readily available
isotopically labelled reagent for a non-isotopically labelled reagent.
— 32 —
The compounds described in the invention can be present as a
solvate. In some cases, the solvent used to prepare the solvate is an aqueous
solution, and the solvate is then often referred to as a hydrate. The compounds can
be present as a hydrate, which can be obtained, for example, by crystallization from
a solvent or from aqueous solution. In this connection, one, two, three or any
arbitrary number of solvate or water molecules can combine with the compounds
according to the invention to form solvates and hydrates. Unless stated to the
contrary, the invention includes all such possible solvates.
The term ―co-crystal‖ means a physical association of two or more
molecules which owe their stability through non-covalent interaction. One or more
components of this molecular complex provide a stable framework in the crystalline
lattice. In certain instances, the guest molecules are incorporated in the crystalline
lattice as anhydrates or solvates, see e.g. ―Crystal Engineering of the Composition of
Pharmaceutical Phases. Do Pharmaceutical Co-crystals Represent a New Path to
Improved Medicines?‖ Almarasson, O., et. al., The Royal Society of Chemistry,
1889-1896, 2004. Examples of co-crystals include p-toluenesulfonic acid and
benzenesulfonic acid.
It is also appreciated that certain compounds described herein can be
present as an equilibrium of tautomers. For example, ketones with an α-hydrogen
can exist in an equilibrium of the keto form and the enol form.
Likewise, amides with an N-hydrogen can exist in an equilibrium of the
amide form and the imidic acid form. Unless stated to the contrary, the invention
includes all such possible tautomers.
It is known that chemical substances form solids which are present in
different states of order which are termed polymorphic forms or modifications. The
different modifications of a polymorphic substance can differ greatly in their physical
properties. The compounds according to the invention can be present in different
— 33 —
polymorphic forms, with it being possible for particular modifications to be
metastable. Unless stated to the contrary, the invention includes all such possible
polymorphic forms.
In some aspects, a structure of a compound can be represented by a
formula:
which is understood to be equivalent to a formula:
n(a)
n(b)
n(c)
n(e)
n(d)
wherein n is typically an integer. That is, R is understood to represent
n(a) n(b) n(c) n(d) n(e)
five independent substituents, R , R , R , R , R . By ―independent
substituents,‖ it is meant that each R substituent can be independently defined. For
n(a) n(b)
example, if in one instance R is halogen, then R is not necessarily halogen in
that instance.
Certain materials, compounds, compositions, and components
disclosed herein can be obtained commercially or readily synthesized using
techniques generally known to those of skill in the art. For example, the starting
materials and reagents used in preparing the disclosed compounds and
compositions are either available from commercial suppliers such as Sigma-Aldrich
Chemical Co., (Milwaukee, WI.), Acros Organics (Morris Plains, NJ), Fisher Scientific
(Pittsburgh, PA.), or Sigma (St. Louis, MO.) or are prepared by methods known to
those skilled in the art following procedures set forth in references such as Fieser
and Fieser’s Reagents for Organic Synthesis, Volumes 1-17 (John Wiley and Sons,
1991); Rodd’s Chemistry of Carbon Compounds, Volumes 1-5 and Supplementals
(Elsevier Science Publishers, 1989); Organic Reactions, Volumes 1-40 (John Wiley
and Sons, 1991); March‘s Advanced Organic Chemistry, (John Wiley and Sons, 4th
— 34 —
Edition); and Larock‘s Comprehensive Organic Transformations (VCH Publishers
Inc., 1989).
Unless otherwise expressly stated, it is in no way intended that any
method set forth herein be construed as requiring that its steps be performed in a
specific order. Accordingly, where a method claim does not actually recite an order
to be followed by its steps or it is not otherwise specifically stated in the claims or
descriptions that the steps are to be limited to a specific order, it is no way intended
that an order be inferred, in any respect. This holds for any possible non-express
basis for interpretation, including: matters of logic with respect to arrangement of
steps or operational flow; plain meaning derived from grammatical organization or
punctuation; and the number or type of embodiments described in the specification.
Disclosed are the components to be used to prepare the compositions
of the invention as well as the compositions themselves to be used within the
methods disclosed herein. These and other materials are disclosed herein, and it is
understood that when combinations, subsets, interactions, groups, etc. of these
materials are disclosed that while specific reference of each various individual and
collective combinations and permutation of these compounds can not be explicitly
disclosed, each is specifically contemplated and described herein. For example, if a
particular compound is disclosed and discussed and a number of modifications that
can be made to a number of molecules including the compounds are discussed,
specifically contemplated is each and every combination and permutation of the
compound and the modifications that are possible unless specifically indicated to the
contrary. Thus, if a class of molecules A, B, and C are disclosed as well as a class
of molecules D, E, and F and an example of a combination molecule, A-D is
disclosed, then even if each is not individually recited each is individually and
collectively contemplated meaning combinations, A-E, A-F, B-D, B-E, B-F, C-D, C-E,
and C-F are considered disclosed. Likewise, any subset or combination of these is
also disclosed. Thus, for example, the sub-group of A-E, B-F, and C-E would be
considered disclosed. This concept applies to all aspects of this application
including, but not limited to, steps in methods of making and using the compositions
of the invention. Thus, if there are a variety of additional steps that can be
— 35 —
performed it is understood that each of these additional steps can be performed with
any specific embodiment or combination of embodiments of the methods of the
invention.
It is understood that the compositions disclosed herein have certain
functions. Disclosed herein are certain structural requirements for performing the
disclosed functions, and it is understood that there are a variety of structures that
can perform the same function that are related to the disclosed structures, and that
these structures will typically achieve the same result.
B. COMPOUNDS
In one aspect, the invention relates to compounds useful as inhibitors
of histone demethylase. In a further aspect, the compounds are useful as inhibitors
of lysine-specific histone demethylase (―LSD‖). Moreover, in one aspect, the
compounds of the invention are useful in the treatment of disorders of uncontrolled
cellular proliferations. In a further aspect, the disorder of uncontrolled cellular
proliferation is a cancer or a tumor. In a still further aspect, the disorder of
uncontrolled cellular proliferation is associated with a LSD dysfunction, as further
described herein.
It is contemplated that each disclosed derivative can be optionally
further substituted. It is also contemplated that any one or more derivative can be
optionally omitted from the invention. It is understood that a disclosed compound
can be provided by the disclosed methods. It is also understood that the disclosed
compounds can be employed in the disclosed methods of using.
1. STRUCTURE
In one aspect, the invention provides a compound having a structure
represented by a formula:
— 36 —
NH m
(I),
wherein
m is 1;
n is an integer from 0 to 3;
Z is independently selected from N and CH;
R is selected from halo, C1-C3 haloalkyl, and C1-C3 polyhaloalkyl;
each of R , R , and R is independently selected from hydrogen, halo, hydroxyl,
2 3 4
cyano, amino, C2-C6 alkalkoxy, C1-C6 alkoxy, C1-C6 alkyl, C1-C6 polyhaloalkyl,
and C1-C6 haloalkyl;
R is selected from NR and Cy, and substituted with 0-3 groups independently
selected from halo, hydroxyl, amino, cyano, C2-C6 alkalkoxy, C1-C6 alkylalcohol,
C1-C6 alkoxy, C1-C6 alkyl, C1-C6 polyhaloalkyl, C1-C6 haloalkyl, C3-C6 cycloalkyl,
and Cy;
Cy is a heterocycloalkyl selected from aziridinyl, azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl,
azepanyl, oxazolidinyl, imidazolidinyl, pyrazolidinyl, piperazinyl, oxazinanyl,
morpholinyl, hexahydrophyrimidinyl, and hexahydropyridazinyl; and
R is selected from hydrogen, C1-C6 alkyl, C3-C6 cycloalkyl, and C3-C6
heterocycloalkyl;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
— 37 —
[00116a] Also described is a compound having a structure represented by
Formula (I):
NH m
(I),
wherein
m is 0 or 1;
n is an integer from 0 to 3;
Z is independently selected from N and CH;
R is selected from halo, C1-C3 haloalkyl, and C1-C3 polyhaloalkyl;
each of R , R , and R is independently selected from hydrogen, halo, hydroxyl,
2 3 4
cyano, amino, C2-C6 alkalkoxy, C1-C6 alkoxy, C1-C6 alkyl, C1-C6 polyhaloalkyl,
and C1-C6 haloalkyl;
R is selected from NR R , C1-C6 alkyl, C3-C6 cycloalkyl, and Cy, and substituted
6 7
with 0-3 groups independently selected from halo, hydroxyl, amino, C2-C6 alkalkoxy,
C1-C6 alkylalcohol, C1-C6 alkoxy, C1-C6 alkyl, C1-C6 polyhaloalkyl, C1-C6
haloalkyl, C3-C6 cycloalkyl, and Cy;
Cy is a heterocycloalkyl selected from aziridinyl, azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl,
azepanyl, oxazolidinyl, imidazolidinyl, pyrazolidinyl, piperazinyl, oxazinanyl,
morpholinyl, hexahydrophyrimidinyl, and hexahydropyridazinyl; and
each of R and R is independently selected from hydrogen, C1-C6 alkyl, C3-C6
cycloalkyl, and C3-C6 heterocycloalkyl;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
— 38 —
In some embodiments, R is selected from:
8b 8b
R R R R
8a 8c 8a 8c
8d 8d
8e , 8e , ,
, , , ,
wherein
each of R , R , R , R , and R is independently selected from hydrogen, halo,
8a 8b 8c 8d 8e
amino, cyano, hydroxyl, C2-C6 alkoxyalkyl, C1-C3 alkoxy, C1-C3 haloalkyl, and C1-
C3 polyhaloalkyl, and C1-C6 alkyl, and
each of R , R , R , and R is independently selected from hydrogen, amino, halo,
9a 9b 9c 9d
hydroxyl, C1-C3 alkyl, C1-C3 alkoxy, C1-C3 haloalkyl, C1-C3 polyhaloalkyl,
aziridinyl, azetidinyl, and pyrollidinyl.
In some embodiments, the invention provides a compound selected
from the group consisting of:
— 39 —
— 40 —
— 41 —
F , and
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
In yet other embodiments, the invention provides a compound having a
structure represented by a formula:
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
In yet other embodiments, the invention provides a compound having a
structure represented by a formula:
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
In yet other embodiments, the invention provides a compound having a
structure represented by a formula:
— 42 —
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
[00121a] In yet another embodiment, the invention provides compound having a
structure represented by a formula:
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
Also described is a pharmaceutical composition comprising a
therapeutically effective amount of any of a compound described herein and a
pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
Also described is a method for the treatment of a disorder of
uncontrolled cellular proliferation in a mammal, the method comprising the step of
administering to the mammal an effective amount of any of the compounds
described herein.
Also described is a method for decreasing histone demethylase activity
in a mammal, the method comprising the step of administering to the mammal an
effective amount of any of the compounds described herein.
2. INHIBITION OF HISTONE DEMETHYLASE ACTIVITY
In one aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit inhibition of LSD
protein activity. In a yet further aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit selective
inhibition of LSD1 protein activity. In an even further aspect, the disclosed
compounds exhibit selective inhibition of LSD2 protein activity. In a still further
aspect, the disclosed compounds inhibit LSD demethylase activity. In a still further
— 43 —
aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit binding to the FAD domain of LSD. In an
even further aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit inhibition of LSD-mediated
demethylation of histone 3 (H3) at the Lys4 position. In a still further aspect, the
disclosed compounds exhibit inhibition LSD-mediated demethylation of H3K3m1 and
H3K4me2. In a yet further aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit inhibition LSD-
mediated demethylation of H3K9me2 and H3K9me1.
In a still further aspect, the disclosed compounds inhibit LSD1
demethylase activity. In a still further aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit
binding to the FAD domain of LSD1. In an even further aspect, the disclosed
compounds exhibit inhibition of LSD1-mediated demethylation of histone 3 (H3) at
the Lys4 position. In a still further aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit inhibition
LSD1-mediated demethylation of H3K3m1 and H3K4me2. In a yet further aspect,
the disclosed compounds exhibit inhibition LSD1-mediated demethylation of
H3K9me2 and H3K9me1.
In a still further aspect, the disclosed compounds inhibit LSD2
demethylase activity. In a still further aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit
binding to the FAD domain of LSD2. In an even further aspect, the disclosed
compounds exhibit inhibition of LSD2-mediated demethylation of histone 3 (H3) at
the Lys4 position. In a still further aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit inhibition
LSD2-mediated demethylation of H3K3m1 and H3K4me2.
In a further aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit disruption of of
LSD interaction with a complexes comprising one or more of HDAC1/2, CoREST,
CtBP1, BRAF35 and BHC80 proteins. In a still further aspect, the disclosed
compounds disrupt binding of LSD1 to one or more proteins selected from
HDAC1/2, CoREST, CtBP1, BRAF35 and BHC80 proteins. In a still further aspect,
the disclosed compounds disrupt binding of LSD2 to one or more proteins selected
from G9a, NSD3, HDAC1/2, CoREST, CtBP1, BRAF35 and BHC80 proteins.
Inhibition of LSD activity can be determined by a variety of both in vitro
and in vivo methods known to one skilled in the art. For example, enzymatic activity
can be determined in in vitro enzyme assay systems. In various aspects, the
enzymatic activity of either LSD1 or LSD2 can be determined in a spectrophometric
— 44 —
assay. Briefly, the assay is based on the multistep enzymatic reaction in which
LSD1 or LSD2 first produces H O during the demethylation of lysine 4 on a peptide
corresponding to the first 21 amino acids of the N-terminal tail of histone H3. In the
presence of horseradish peroxidase, the H O produced reacts with ADHP to
produce the highly fluorescent compound resorufin that can be analyzed with an
excitation wavelength of 530-540 nm and an emission wavelength of 585-595 nm.
The assay requires a source of LSD1 or LSD2 enzyme, either purified from natural
sources (e.g. a tissue or cultured cells), isolated as a recombinantly expressed
protein, or as a unpurified protein in whole cell extracts. In one aspect, the disclosed
compounds exhibit inhibition of LSD protein activity with an IC in an EMSA assay
of less than about about 300 M, less than about about 100 M, less than about 50
M, less than about 10 M, less than about 1 M, less than about 500 nM, or of less
than about 100 nM. In a further aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit inhibition
of LSD1 protein activity with an IC in an EMSA assay of less than about about 300
M, less than about about 100 M, less than about 50 M, less than about 10 M,
less than about 1 M, less than about 500 nM, or of less than about 100 nM. In a
still further aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit inhibition of LSD2 protein
activity with an IC in an EMSA assay of less than about about 300 M, less than
about about 100 M, less than about 50 M, less than about 10 M, less than about
1 M, less than about 500 nM, or of less than about 100 nM.
In one aspect, the disclosed compounds are selective for LSD. In a
further aspect, selective inhibition of LSD activity is determined using an enzyme
assay. In various further aspects, the compound inhibits LSD activity in an enzyme
assay with an IC less than the IC for MAO A and/or MAO B. That is, a disclosed
50 50
compound can have selectivity for the LSD protein vis-à-vis MAO A and/or MAO B.
For example, in one aspect, a disclosed compound can inhibit LSD with an IC of
about 5-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 10-fold less than that for MAO A, of
about 20-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 30-fold less than that for MAO A, of
about 50-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 100-fold less than that for MAO A,
of about 250-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 500-fold less than that for MAO
A, of about 1000-fold less than that for MAO A, and more than about 1000-fold less
than that for MAO A. In a further aspect, a disclosed compound can inhibit LSD with
— 45 —
an IC of about 5-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 10-fold less than that for
MAO B, of about 20-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 30-fold less than that for
MAO B, of about 50-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 100-fold less than that
for MAO B, of about 250-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 500-fold less than
that for MAO B, of about 1000-fold less than that for MAO B, and more than about
1000-fold less than that for MAO B.
In one aspect, the disclosed compounds are selective for LSD1. In a
further aspect, selective inhibition of LSD1 activity is determined using an enzyme
assay. In various further aspects, the compound inhibits LSD1 activity in an enzyme
assay with an IC less than the IC for one or more of LSD2, MAO A, and MAO B.
50 50
That is, a disclosed compound can have selectivity for the LSD1 protein vis-à-vis
one or more of of LSD2, MAO A, and MAO B. For example, in one aspect, a
disclosed compound can inhibit LSD1 with an IC of about 5-fold less than that for
LSD2, of about 10-fold less than that for LSD2, of about 20-fold less than that for
LSD2, of about 30-fold less than that for LSD2, or of about 50-fold less than that for
LSD2. In a further aspect, a disclosed compound can inhibit LSD1 with an IC of
about 5-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 10-fold less than that for MAO A, of
about 20-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 30-fold less than that for MAO A, of
about 50-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 100-fold less than that for MAO A,
of about 250-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 500-fold less than that for MAO
A, of about 1000-fold less than that for MAO A, and more than about 1000-fold less
than that for MAO A. In a further aspect, a disclosed compound can inhibit LSD1
with an IC of about 5-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 10-fold less than that
for MAO B, of about 20-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 30-fold less than that
for MAO B, of about 50-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 100-fold less than
that for MAO B, of about 250-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 500-fold less
than that for MAO B, of about 1000-fold less than that for MAO B, and more than
about 1000-fold less than that for MAO B.
In one aspect, the disclosed compounds are selective for LSD2. In a
further aspect, selective inhibition of LSD2 activity is determined using an enzyme
assay. In various further aspects, the compound inhibits LSD2 activity in an enzyme
assay with an IC less than the IC for one or more of LSD1, MAO A, and MAO B.
50 50
— 46 —
That is, a disclosed compound can have selectivity for the LSD2 protein vis-à-vis
one or more of of LSD1, MAO A, and MAO B. For example, in one aspect, a
disclosed compound can inhibit LSD2 with an IC of about 5-fold less than that for
LSD1, of about 10-fold less than that for LSD1, of about 20-fold less than that for
LSD1, of about 30-fold less than that for LSD1, or of about 50-fold less than that for
LSD1. In a further aspect, a disclosed compound can inhibit LSD2 with an IC of
about 5-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 10-fold less than that for MAO A, of
about 20-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 30-fold less than that for MAO A, of
about 50-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 100-fold less than that for MAO A,
of about 250-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 500-fold less than that for MAO
A, of about 1000-fold less than that for MAO A, and more than about 1000-fold less
than that for MAO A. In a further aspect, a disclosed compound can inhibit LSD2
with an IC of about 5-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 10-fold less than that
for MAO B, of about 20-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 30-fold less than that
for MAO B, of about 50-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 100-fold less than
that for MAO B, of about 250-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 500-fold less
than that for MAO B, of about 1000-fold less than that for MAO B, and more than
about 1000-fold less than that for MAO B.
In various aspects, the disclosed compounds exhibit binding to a LSD
protein. In a further aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit binding to the FAD
domain of a LSD protein. In a still further aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit
binding to LSD1 protein. In an even further aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit
binding to LSD2 protein. The binding affinity of a disclosed compound for a LSD
protein, e.g. LSD1 protein, can be determined by various methods known to one
skilled in the art. In one aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit binding to LSD
protein with a K of less than about about 50 M, less than about 10 M, less than
about 1 M, less than about 500 nM, or of less than about 100 nM. In a further
aspect, the K is determined using an SPR method. In a still further aspect, the
binding is determined using LSD1 protein. In a yet further aspect, the binding is
determined using LSD2 protein.
In various further aspects, the binding to LSD is selective. In a further
aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit a K for LSD binding less than the K of
— 47 —
MAO A and/or MAO B. That is, a disclosed compound can have selectivity for the
LSD protein vis-à-vis MAO A and/or MAO B proteins. For example, in one aspect, a
disclosed compound can bind LSD with a K of about 5-fold less than that for MAO
A, of about 10-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 20-fold less than that for MAO
A, of about 30-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 50-fold less than that for MAO
A, of about 100-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 250-fold less than that for
MAO A, of about 500-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 1000-fold less than that
for MAO A, and of more than about 1000-fold less than that for MAO A. In a further
aspect, a disclosed compound can bind LSD with a K of about 5-fold less than that
for MAO B, of about 10-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 20-fold less than that
for MAO B, of about 30-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 50-fold less than that
for MAO B, of about 100-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 250-fold less than
that for MAO B, of about 500-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 1000-fold less
than that for MAO B, and of more than about 1000-fold less than that for MAO B.
In various further aspects, the binding to LSD1 is selective. In a further
aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit a K for LSD1 binding less than the K for
one or more of LSD2, MAO A, and MAO B. That is, a disclosed compound can
have selectivity for the LSD1 protein vis-à-vis one or more of of LSD2, MAO A, and
MAO B proteins. For example, in one aspect, a disclosed compound can bind LSD1
with a K of about 5-fold less than that for LSD2, of about 10-fold less than that for
LSD2, of about 20-fold less than that for LSD2, of about 30-fold less than that for
LSD2, or of about 50-fold less than that for LSD2. In a further aspect, a disclosed
compound can bind LSD1 with a K of about 5-fold less than that for MAO A, of
about 10-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 20-fold less than that for MAO A, of
about 30-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 50-fold less than that for MAO A, of
about 100-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 250-fold less than that for MAO A,
of about 500-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 1000-fold less than that for
MAO A, and of more than about 1000-fold less than that for MAO A. In a further
aspect, a disclosed compound can bind LSD1 with a K of about 5-fold less than
that for MAO B, of about 10-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 20-fold less than
that for MAO B, of about 30-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 50-fold less than
that for MAO B, of about 100-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 250-fold less
than that for MAO B, of about 500-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 1000-fold
— 48 —
less than that for MAO B, and of more than about 1000-fold less than that for MAO
In various further aspects, the binding to LSD2 is selective. In a further
aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit a K for LSD2 binding less than the K for
one or more of LSD1, MAO A, and MAO B. That is, a disclosed compound can
have selectivity for the LSD2 protein vis-à-vis one or more of of LSD1, MAO A, and
MAO B proteins. For example, in one aspect, a disclosed compound can bind LSD2
with a K of about 5-fold less than that for LSD1, of about 10-fold less than that for
LSD1, of about 20-fold less than that for LSD1, of about 30-fold less than that for
LSD1, or of about 50-fold less than that for LSD1. In a further aspect, a disclosed
compound can bind LSD2 with a K of about 5-fold less than that for MAO A, of
about 10-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 20-fold less than that for MAO A, of
about 30-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 50-fold less than that for MAO A, of
about 100-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 250-fold less than that for MAO A,
of about 500-fold less than that for MAO A, of about 1000-fold less than that for
MAO A, and of more than about 1000-fold less than that for MAO A. In a further
aspect, a disclosed compound can bind LSD2 with a K of about 5-fold less than
that for MAO B, of about 10-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 20-fold less than
that for MAO B, of about 30-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 50-fold less than
that for MAO B, of about 100-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 250-fold less
than that for MAO B, of about 500-fold less than that for MAO B, of about 1000-fold
less than that for MAO B, and of more than about 1000-fold less than that for MAO
Alternatively, the inhibition of STAT protein activity can be determined
in a cell-based assay. There are a variety of cell-based assays that are suitable for
determination of inhibition of LSD protein activity known to one skilled in the art. For
example, cell growth inhibition or cell arrest can be determined using a cell, either a
permanent cell-line or a primary cell culture that has a LSD protein with dysfunction
activity. In a further aspect, the LSD protein is LSD1. In a still further aspect, the
LSD protein is LSD2. In a yet further aspect, the LSD protein dysfunction is one
wherein the LSD protein is has acquired a gain of function mutation. Alternatively,
the LSD protein dysfunction has a phenotype of persistent or constitutive activity.
— 49 —
For example, the LSD protein can have a persistent or constitutive activity due to a
dysfunction in an upstream regulatory protein. In a further aspect, the LSD protein is
overexpressed due to a dysfunction in regulation of transcription and/or translation of
the LSD gene. In a further aspect, the cell harbors an active oncogene is associated
with LSD dysfunction.
In one aspect, the disclosed compounds and products of disclosed
methods of making inhibit cell growth. In a still further aspect, the disclosed
compounds and products of disclosed methods inhibit cell growth in an in vitro assay
system. In an even further aspect, the in vitro assay system makes use of a cell-line
derived from a from cancer or tumor selected from breast cancer, ovarian cancer,
testicular cancer, lung cancer, liver cancer, prostate cancer, pancreatic cancer and a
sarcoma. In a yet further aspect, the cell-line is derived from a human source. In a
yet further aspect, the disclosed compounds inhibit cell growth in a cell with a
persistently active LSD protein. In an even further aspect, the cell-line has an
activated LSD protein. In a still further aspect, the cell-line is selected from AN3 CA,
BT-20, BT-549, HCT 116, HER218, MCF7, MDA-MB-231, MDA-MB-235, MDA-MB-
435S, MDA-MB-468, PANC-1, PC-3, SK-N-MC, T-47D, and U-87 MG. In one
aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit inhibition of cell growth activity in an in vitro
cell-based assay with an IC of less than about about 500 M, of less than about
about 250 M, less than about about 100 M, less than about 50 M, less than
about 10 M, less than about 1 M, less than about 500 nM, of less than about 100
nM, of less than about 10 nM, and of less than about 1 nM.
In one aspect, the disclosed compounds and products of disclosed
methods of making inhibit cell migration. In a still further aspect, the disclosed
compounds and products of disclosed methods inhibit cell migration in an in vitro
assay system. In an even further aspect, the in vitro assay system makes use of a
cell-line derived from a from cancer or tumor selected from breast cancer, ovarian
cancer, testicular cancer, lung cancer, liver cancer, prostate cancer, pancreatic
cancer and a sarcoma. In a yet further aspect, the cell-line is derived from a human
source. In a yet further aspect, the disclosed compounds inhibit cell growth in a cell
with a persistently active LSD protein. In an even further aspect, the cell-line has an
activated LSD protein. In a still further aspect, the cell-line is selected from AN3 CA,
— 50 —
BT-20, BT-549, HCT 116, HER218, MCF7, MDA-MB-231, MDA-MB-235, MDA-MB-
435S, MDA-MB-468, PANC-1, PC-3, SK-N-MC, T-47D, and U-87 MG. In one
aspect, the disclosed compounds exhibit inhibition of cell migration in an in vitro cell-
based assay with an IC of less than about about 300 M, less than about about
100 M, less than about 50 M, less than about 10 M, less than about 1 M, less
than about 500 nM, or of less than about 100 nM.
C. METHODS OF MAKING THE COMPOUNDS
Also described are methods of making compounds useful as inhibitors
of LSD. In a further aspect, the products of disclosed methods of making are
modulators of LSD activity. In a yet further aspect, the products of disclosed
methods of making bind to a STAT protein and negatively modulate LSD activity.
The compounds can, in one aspect, exhibit subtype selectivity. In a still further
aspect, the products of disclosed methods of making exhibit selectivity for the LSD1
member of the LSD protein family. In an even further aspect, the products of the
disclosed methods of making exhibit selectivity for the LSD2 member of the LSD
protein family.
Also described are methods of making compounds useful as inhibitors
of histone demethylase, which can be useful in the treatment of disorders of
uncontrolled cellular proliferation. In a further aspect, the histone demethylase is
LSD1. In a yet further aspect, the histone demethylase is LSD2.
The compounds described herein can be prepared by employing
reactions as shown in the following schemes, in addition to other standard
manipulations that are known in the literature, exemplified in the experimental
sections or clear to one skilled in the art. For clarity, examples having a single
substituent are shown where multiple substituents are allowed under the definitions
disclosed herein.
Reactions used to generate the compounds described herein are
prepared by employing reactions as shown in the following Reaction Schemes, in
addition to other standard manipulations known in the literature or to one skilled in
— 51 —
the art. The following examples are provided so that the invention might be more
fully understood, are illustrative only, and should not be construed as limiting.
In one aspect, the disclosed compounds comprise the products of the
synthetic methods described herein. In a further aspect, the disclosed compounds
comprise a compound produced by a synthetic method described herein. In a still
further aspect, the invention comprises a pharmaceutical composition comprising a
therapeutically effective amount of the product of the disclosed methods and a
pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. In a still further aspect, the invention comprises
a method for manufacturing a medicament comprising combining at least one
compound of any of disclosed compounds or at least one product of the disclosed
methods with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or diluent.
1. ROUTE I
In one aspect, substituted (E)-N‘-(1-phenylethylidene)benzohydrazide
analogs described herein can be prepared generically by the synthetic scheme as
shown below.
9a 9b
H-N O 9a 9b
O R 3
9d 9d
S N O
9d 9c
R Z R 2 4
R Z R
X = Cl, Br, I or leaving group
9a 9b
NH NH N
CH OH
9d 9c
R Z R
2 9c
— 52 —
CH 9d 9c
R Z R
Compounds are represented in generic form, with substituents as
noted in compound descriptions elsewhere herein. A more specific example is set
forth below.
9a 9b
H-N O
R9a R
O R 3
9d 9d
S Cl
S N O
K CO , THF, rt, 1 h
9d 9c
2 4 R R
R Z R 2 4
R Z R
9a 9b
NH NH N
CH OH O
CH OH, 70 C,
cat. H SO ,
9d 9c
overnight
9d R Z R
65 C, 12 h
2 9c
R 4 R
— 53 —
cat. CH CO H, CH OH,
3 2 3
CH 9d 9c
120°C, 0.5 h 2 4 R R
R Z R
microwave reactor
In one aspect, Route I begins with a suitable substituted acid derivative
(1.1). Suitable substituted acid derivatives (1.1) are commercially available or can
be readily prepared by one skilled in the art. In a typical reaction, compound of the
type 1.1 is added to the amine derivative of type 1.2 in the presence of a suitable
base, e.g., potassium carbonate, in suitable solvent such as THF. The reaction is
stirred at room temperature (about 15-30 °C) for a time sufficient to complete the
reaction, e.g., about twelve hours. After completion of the reaction, the solvent is
removed under vacuum, and the compound of type 1.3 is isolated and purified by
chromatography.
In one aspect, compounds of type 1.4 can be prepared by reaction of
compounds of type 1.3 with an alcohol by an esterification reaction. In a typical
reaction, a compound of type 1.3 is heated at a suitable temperature (e.g., at reflux,
about 65 °C) in a suitable alcoholic solvent, e.g., methanol, in the presence of an
acid catalyst such as concentrated sulfuric acid for a time sufficient to complete the
reaction, e.g., overnight (about 8-18 h). After completion of the reaction, the solvent
is removed under vacuum, and the compound of type 1.4, is isolated and purified by
chromatography.
In one aspect, compounds of type 1.4 can provide compounds of type
1.5 by reaction with an appropriate hydrazine derivative (NH2NHR4). In a typical
reaction, a compound of type 1.4 is added to a suitable hydrazine derivative
(NH2NHR4) and heated at suitable temperature (e.g., at reflux, about 65 °C) in a
suitable solvent, e.g., methanol, for a time sufficient to complete the reaction (e.g.,
— 54 —
about 12 h). After completion of the reaction, the solvent is removed under vacuum,
and the compound of type 1.5, is isolated and purified by chromatography.
In one aspect, compounds of type 1.5 can provide compounds of type
1.7 by reaction with an appropriate carbonyl-containing compound (1.6). In a typical
reaction, a compound of type 1.6 and a suitable hydrazine derivative (1.5) are
dissolved in a suitable solvent, e.g., methanol, in the presence of a suitable acid
catalyst (e.g., acetic acid), and the mixture is heated using a microwave reactor at
suitable temperature, e.g., about 120 °C, for a time sufficient to complete the
reaction (e.g., about 30 min). After completion of the reaction and following cooling,
the solvent is removed under vacuum, and the compounds of type 1.7, are isolated
and purified by chromatography.
2. ROUTE II
In one aspect, substituted (E)-N‘-(1-phenylethylidene)benzohydrazide
analogs described herein can be prepared generically by the synthetic scheme as
shown below.
HO n
NH NH
CH OH
R Z R
R OH
O R O R
CH
S R 3
2 4 3
R Z R
R Z R
— 55 —
Compounds are represented in generic form, with substituents as
noted in compound descriptions elsewhere herein. A more specific example is set
forth below.
NH NH
CH OH R
HO 3 O
CH OH, 70 C,
cat. H SO ,
o overnight
70 C, 12 h
H N 5
CH
cat. CH CO H, CH OH,
3 2 3
120 C, 0.5 h 3
R Z R
R Z R
microwave reactor
In one aspect, Route II begins with a suitable substituted acid
derivative (2.1). Suitable substituted acid derivatives (2.1) are commercially
available or can be readily prepared by one skilled in the art. In one aspect,
compounds of type 2.2 can be prepared by reaction of compounds of type 2.1 with
an alcohol by an esterification reaction. In a typical reaction, a compound of type
2.1 is heated at a suitable temperature (e.g., at reflux, about 70 °C) in a suitable
alcoholic solvent, e.g., methanol, in the presence of an acid catalyst such as
concentrated sulfuric acid for a time sufficient to complete the reaction, e.g.,
overnight (about 8-18 h). After completion of the reaction, the solvent is removed
under vacuum, and the compound of type 2.2, is isolated and purified by
chromatography.
In one aspect, compounds of type 2.2 can be provide compounds of
type 2.3 by reaction with an appropriate hydrazine derivative (NH NHR ). In a
typical reaction, a compound of type 2.2 is added to a suitable hydrazine derivative
— 56 —
(NH NHR ) and heated a suitable temperature (e.g., at reflux, about 70 °C) in a
suitable solvent, e.g., methanol for time sufficient to complete the reaction such as
overnight (8-18 h). After completion of the reaction, the solvent is removed under
vacuum, and the compound of type 2.3, is isolated and purified by chromatography.
In one aspect, compounds of type 2.3 can be used to provide
compounds of type 2.5 by reaction with an appropriate carbonyl-containing
compound (2.4). In a typical reaction, a compound of type 2.4 and a suitable
hydrazine derivative (2.3) are dissolved in a suitable solvent, e.g., methanol, in the
presence of a suitable acid catalyst (e.g., acetic acid), and the mixture is heated
using a microwave reactor at suitable temperature, e.g., about 120 °C, at a time
sufficient to complete the reaction (e.g., about 30 min). After completion of the
reaction and following cooling, the solvent is removed under vacuum, and the
compounds of type 2.5, are isolated and purified by chromatography.
In a further aspect, the compound produced exhibits inhibiton of a
histone demethylase. In a still further aspect, the histone demethyalse is a member
of the lysine-specific (―LSD‖) family of histone demethyalases. In yet further aspect,
the histone demethylase is LSD1. In an even further aspect, the histone
demethylase is LSD2. In a still further aspect, the compound produced exhibits
inhibition of cell viability.
In a further aspect, the compound produced exhibits inhibition with an
IC of less than about 1.0 10 M. In a still further aspect, the compound produced
exhibits inhibition with an IC of less than about 1.0 10 M. In a yet further aspect,
the compound produced exhibits inhibition with an IC of less than about 1.0 10
M. In an even further aspect, the compound produced exhibits inhibition with an IC
of less than about 1.0 10 M. In a still further aspect, the compound produced
exhibits inhibition with an IC of less than about 1.0 10 M. In a yet further aspect,
the compound produced exhibits inhibition with an IC of less than about 1.0 10
It is contemplated that each disclosed methods can further comprise
additional steps, manipulations, and/or components. It is also contemplated that any
one or more step, manipulation, and/or component can be optionally omitted from
— 57 —
the invention. It is understood that a disclosed methods can be used to provide the
disclosed compounds. It is also understood that the products of the disclosed
methods can be employed in the disclosed methods of using.
D. PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITIONS
In one aspect, described are pharmaceutical compositions comprising
the disclosed compounds. That is, a pharmaceutical composition can be provided
comprising a therapeutically effective amount of at least one disclosed compound or
at least one product of a disclosed method and a pharmaceutically acceptable
carrier.
In a further aspect, described are pharmaceutical compositions
comprising a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier and an effective amount of the
product of a disclosed synthetic method. In a further aspect, the effective amount is
a therapeutically effective amount. In a further aspect, the effective amount is a
prophylactically effective amount. In a further aspect, the compound is a disclosed
compound.
In certain aspects, the disclosed pharmaceutical compositions
comprise the disclosed compounds (including pharmaceutically acceptable salt(s)
thereof) as an active ingredient, a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and,
optionally, other therapeutic ingredients or adjuvants. The instant compositions
include those suitable for oral, rectal, topical, and parenteral (including
subcutaneous, intramuscular, and intravenous) administration, although the most
suitable route in any given case will depend on the particular host, and nature and
severity of the conditions for which the active ingredient is being administered. The
pharmaceutical compositions can be conveniently presented in unit dosage form
and prepared by any of the methods well known in the art of pharmacy.
As used herein, the term ―pharmaceutically acceptable salts‖ refers to
salts prepared from pharmaceutically acceptable non-toxic bases or acids. When
the compound of the present invention is acidic, its corresponding salt can be
conveniently prepared from pharmaceutically acceptable non-toxic bases, including
inorganic bases and organic bases. Salts derived from such inorganic bases include
— 58 —
aluminum, ammonium, calcium, copper (-ic and -ous), ferric, ferrous, lithium,
magnesium, manganese (-ic and -ous), potassium, sodium, zinc and the like salts.
Particularly preferred are the ammonium, calcium, magnesium, potassium and
sodium salts. Salts derived from pharmaceutically acceptable organic non-toxic
bases include salts of primary, secondary, and tertiary amines, as well as cyclic
amines and substituted amines such as naturally occurring and synthesized
substituted amines. Other pharmaceutically acceptable organic non-toxic bases
from which salts can be formed include ion exchange resins such as, for example,
arginine, betaine, caffeine, choline, N,N -dibenzylethylenediamine, diethylamine, 2-
diethylaminoethanol, 2-dimethylaminoethanol, ethanolamine, ethylenediamine, N-
ethylmorpholine, N-ethylpiperidine, glucamine, glucosamine, histidine, hydrabamine,
isopropylamine, lysine, methylglucamine, morpholine, piperazine, piperidine,
polyamine resins, procaine, purines, theobromine, triethylamine, trimethylamine,
tripropylamine, tromethamine and the like.
As used herein, the term ―pharmaceutically acceptable non-toxic
acids‖, includes inorganic acids, organic acids, and salts prepared therefrom, for
example, acetic, benzenesulfonic, benzoic, camphorsulfonic, citric, ethanesulfonic,
fumaric, gluconic, glutamic, hydrobromic, hydrochloric, isethionic, lactic, maleic,
malic, mandelic, methanesulfonic, mucic, nitric, pamoic, pantothenic, phosphoric,
succinic, sulfuric, tartaric, p-toluenesulfonic acid and the like. Preferred are citric,
hydrobromic, hydrochloric, maleic, phosphoric, sulfuric, and tartaric acids.
In practice, the compounds described herein, or pharmaceutically
acceptable salts thereof, of this invention can be combined as the active ingredient
in intimate admixture with a pharmaceutical carrier according to conventional
pharmaceutical compounding techniques. The carrier can take a wide variety of
forms depending on the form of preparation desired for administration, e.g., oral or
parenteral (including intravenous). Thus, the pharmaceutical compositions
described herein can be presented as discrete units suitable for oral administration
such as capsules, cachets or tablets each containing a predetermined amount of the
active ingredient. Further, the compositions can be presented as a powder, as
granules, as a solution, as a suspension in an aqueous liquid, as a non-aqueous
liquid, as an oil-in-water emulsion or as a water-in-oil liquid emulsion. In addition to
— 59 —
the common dosage forms set out above, the compounds of the invention, and/or
pharmaceutically acceptable salt(s) thereof, can also be administered by controlled
release means and/or delivery devices. The compositions can be prepared by any
of the methods of pharmacy. In general, such methods include a step of bringing
into association the active ingredient with the carrier that constitutes one or more
necessary ingredients. In general, the compositions are prepared by uniformly and
intimately admixing the active ingredient with liquid carriers or finely divided solid
carriers or both. The product can then be conveniently shaped into the desired
presentation.
Thus, the pharmaceutical compositions described herein can include a
pharmaceutically acceptable carrier and a compound or a pharmaceutically
acceptable salt of the compounds of the invention. The compounds of the invention,
or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, can also be included in pharmaceutical
compositions in combination with one or more other therapeutically active
compounds.
The pharmaceutical carrier employed can be, for example, a solid,
liquid, or gas. Examples of solid carriers include lactose, terra alba, sucrose, talc,
gelatin, agar, pectin, acacia, magnesium stearate, and stearic acid. Examples of
liquid carriers are sugar syrup, peanut oil, olive oil, and water. Examples of gaseous
carriers include carbon dioxide and nitrogen.
In preparing the compositions for oral dosage form, any convenient
pharmaceutical media can be employed. For example, water, glycols, oils, alcohols,
flavoring agents, preservatives, coloring agents and the like can be used to form oral
liquid preparations such as suspensions, elixirs and solutions; while carriers such as
starches, sugars, microcrystalline cellulose, diluents, granulating agents, lubricants,
binders, disintegrating agents, and the like can be used to form oral solid
preparations such as powders, capsules and tablets. Because of their ease of
administration, tablets and capsules are the preferred oral dosage units whereby
solid pharmaceutical carriers are employed. Optionally, tablets can be coated by
standard aqueous or nonaqueous techniques
— 60 —
A tablet containing the composition described herein can be prepared
by compression or molding, optionally with one or more accessory ingredients or
adjuvants. Compressed tablets can be prepared by compressing, in a suitable
machine, the active ingredient in a free-flowing form such as powder or granules,
optionally mixed with a binder, lubricant, inert diluent, surface active or dispersing
agent. Molded tablets can be made by molding in a suitable machine, a mixture of
the powdered compound moistened with an inert liquid diluent.
The pharmaceutical compositions described herein comprise a
compound described herein (or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof) as an
active ingredient, a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and optionally one or more
additional therapeutic agents or adjuvants. The described compositions include
compositions suitable for oral, rectal, topical, and parenteral (including
subcutaneous, intramuscular, and intravenous) administration, although the most
suitable route in any given case will depend on the particular host, and nature and
severity of the conditions for which the active ingredient is being administered. The
pharmaceutical compositions can be conveniently presented in unit dosage form
and prepared by any of the methods well known in the art of pharmacy.
Pharmaceutical compositions described herein suitable for parenteral
administration can be prepared as solutions or suspensions of the active
compounds in water. A suitable surfactant can be included such as, for example,
hydroxypropylcellulose. Dispersions can also be prepared in glycerol, liquid
polyethylene glycols, and mixtures thereof in oils. Further, a preservative can be
included to prevent the detrimental growth of microorganisms.
Pharmaceutical compositions described herein suitable for injectable
use include sterile aqueous solutions or dispersions. Furthermore, the compositions
can be in the form of sterile powders for the extemporaneous preparation of such
sterile injectable solutions or dispersions. In all cases, the final injectable form must
be sterile and must be effectively fluid for easy syringability. The pharmaceutical
compositions must be stable under the conditions of manufacture and storage; thus,
preferably should be preserved against the contaminating action of microorganisms
such as bacteria and fungi. The carrier can be a solvent or dispersion medium
— 61 —
containing, for example, water, ethanol, polyol (e.g., glycerol, propylene glycol and
liquid polyethylene glycol), vegetable oils, and suitable mixtures thereof.
Pharmaceutical compositions described herein can be in a form
suitable for topical use such as, for example, an aerosol, cream, ointment, lotion,
dusting powder, mouth washes, gargles, and the like. Further, the compositions can
be in a form suitable for use in transdermal devices. These formulations can be
prepared, utilizing a compound of the invention, or pharmaceutically acceptable salts
thereof, via conventional processing methods. As an example, a cream or ointment
is prepared by mixing hydrophilic material and water, together with about 5 wt% to
about 10 wt% of the compound, to produce a cream or ointment having a desired
consistency.
Pharmaceutical compositions described herein can be in a form
suitable for rectal administration wherein the carrier is a solid. It is preferable that
the mixture forms unit dose suppositories. Suitable carriers include cocoa butter and
other materials commonly used in the art. The suppositories can be conveniently
formed by first admixing the composition with the softened or melted carrier(s)
followed by chilling and shaping in moulds.
In addition to the aforementioned carrier ingredients, the
pharmaceutical formulations described above can include, as appropriate, one or
more additional carrier ingredients such as diluents, buffers, flavoring agents,
binders, surface-active agents, thickeners, lubricants, preservatives (including anti-
oxidants) and the like. Furthermore, other adjuvants can be included to render the
formulation isotonic with the blood of the intended recipient. Compositions
containing a compound described herein, and/or pharmaceutically acceptable salts
thereof, can also be prepared in powder or liquid concentrate form.
In the treatment conditions which require inhibition or negative
modulation of LSD protein activity an appropriate dosage level will generally be
about 0.01 to 500 mg per kg patient body weight per day and can be administered in
single or multiple doses. Preferably, the dosage level will be about 0.1 to about 250
mg/kg per day; more preferably 0.5 to 100 mg/kg per day. A suitable dosage level
can be about 0.01 to 250 mg/kg per day, about 0.05 to 100 mg/kg per day, or about
— 62 —
0.1 to 50 mg/kg per day. Within this range the dosage can be 0.05 to 0.5, 0.5 to 5.0
or 5.0 to 50 mg/kg per day. For oral administration, the compositions are preferably
provided in the from of tablets containing 1.0 to 1000 miligrams of the active
ingredient, particularly 1.0, 5.0, 10, 15, 20, 25, 50, 75, 100, 150, 200, 250, 300, 400,
500, 600, 750, 800, 900 and 1000 milligrams of the active ingredient for the
symptomatic adjustment of the dosage of the patient to be treated. The compound
can be administered on a regimen of 1 to 4 times per day, preferably once or twice
per day. This dosing regimen can be adjusted to provide the optimal therapeutic
response.
It is understood, however, that the specific dose level for any particular
patient will depend upon a variety of factors. Such factors include the age, body
weight, general health, sex, and diet of the patient. Other factors include the time
and route of administration, rate of excretion, drug combination, and the type and
severity of the particular disease undergoing therapy.
Also described is a method for the manufacture of a medicament for
inhibiting or negatively modulating LSD protein activity (e.g., treatment of a disorder
of uncontrolled cellular proliferation, or one or more neurodegenerative disorders
associated with LSD dysfunction) in mammals (e.g., humans) comprising combining
one or more disclosed compounds, products, or compositions with a
pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or diluent. Thus, in one aspect, described is a
method for manufacturing a medicament comprising combining at least one
disclosed compound or at least one disclosed product with a pharmaceutically
acceptable carrier or diluent.
The disclosed pharmaceutical compositions can further comprise other
therapeutically active compounds, which are usually applied in the treatment of the
above mentioned pathological conditions.
It is understood that the disclosed compositions can be prepared from
the disclosed compounds. It is also understood that the disclosed compositions can
be employed in the disclosed methods of using.
— 63 —
E. METHODS OF USING THE COMPOUNDS AND COMPOSITIONS
The disclosed compounds can be used as single agents or in
combination with one or more other drugs in the treatment, prevention, control,
amelioration or reduction of risk of the aforementioned diseases, disorders and
conditions for which compounds of formula I or the other drugs have utility, where
the combination of drugs together are safer or more effective than either drug alone.
The other drug(s) can be administered by a route and in an amount commonly used
therefore, contemporaneously or sequentially with a disclosed compound. When a
disclosed compound is used contemporaneously with one or more other drugs, a
pharmaceutical composition in unit dosage form containing such drugs and the
disclosed compound is preferred. However, the combination therapy can also be
administered on overlapping schedules. It is also envisioned that the combination of
one or more active ingredients and a disclosed compound will be more efficacious
than either as a single agent.
The pharmaceutical compositions and methods described herein can
further comprise other therapeutically active compounds as noted herein which are
usually applied in the treatment of the above mentioned pathological conditions.
1. TREATMENT METHODS
The compounds disclosed herein are useful for treating, preventing,
ameliorating, controlling or reducing the risk of a variety of disorders wherein the
patient or subject would benefit from inhibition or negative modulation of a LSD
protein. In one aspect, a treatment can include selective inhibition of LSD to an
extent effective to affect histone demethylation activity. Thus, a disorder can be
associated with histone demethylation activity, for example dysfunctional epigenetic
regulation of genes in a cancer cell. In one aspect, provided is a method of treating
or preventing a disorder in a subject comprising the step of administering to the
subject at least one disclosed compound; at least one disclosed pharmaceutical
composition; and/or at least one disclosed product in a dosage and amount effective
to treat the disorder in the subject.
— 64 —
Also described is a method for the treatment of one or more disorders,
for which LSD inhibtion is predicted to be beneficial, in a subject comprising the step
of administering to the subject at least one disclosed compound; at least one
disclosed pharmaceutical composition; and/or at least one disclosed product in a
dosage and amount effective to treat the disorder in the subject.
In one aspect, described is a method for treating a disorder of
uncontrolled cellular proliferation, comprising: administering to a subject at least one
disclosed compound; at least one disclosed pharmaceutical composition; and/or at
least one disclosed product in a dosage and amount effective to treat the disorder in
the subject . In a further aspect, described is a method for treating or preventing a
neurodegenerative disorder, comprising: administering to a subject at least one
disclosed compound; at least one disclosed pharmaceutical composition; and/or at
least one disclosed product in a dosage and amount effective to treat the disorder in
the subject . Also described is a method for the treatment of a disorder in a mammal
comprising the step of administering to the mammal at least one disclosed
compound, composition, or medicament.
Also described is the use of described chemical compositions to treat
diseases or disorders in patients (preferably human) wherein wherein LSD inhibition
would be predicted to have a therapeutic effect, such as disorders of uncontrolled
cellular proliferation (e.g. cancers) and neurodegenerative disorders such as
Alzhiemer‘s disease, Huntington‘s disease, and Parkinson‘s disease, by
administering one or more disclosed compounds or products.
The compounds disclosed herein are useful for treating, preventing,
ameliorating, controlling or reducing the risk of a variety of disorders of uncontrolled
cellular proliferation. In one aspect, the disorder of uncontrolled cellular proliferation
is associated with a histone demethylase dysfunction. In a further aspect, the
histone demethylase dysfunction is disregulation of the LSD. In a still further aspect,
the histone demethylase dysfunction is disregulation of the LSD1. In an even further
aspect, the histone demethylase dysfunction is disregulation of the LSD2.
Also described is a method of use of a disclosed compound,
composition, or medicament. In one aspect, the method of use is directed to the
— 65 —
treatment of a disorder. In a further aspect, the disclosed compounds can be used
as single agents or in combination with one or more other drugs in the treatment,
prevention, control, amelioration or reduction of risk of the aforementioned diseases,
disorders and conditions for which the compound or the other drugs have utility,
where the combination of drugs together are safer or more effective than either drug
alone. The other drug(s) can be administered by a route and in an amount
commonly used therefore, contemporaneously or sequentially with a disclosed
compound. When a disclosed compound is used contemporaneously with one or
more other drugs, a pharmaceutical composition in unit dosage form containing such
drugs and the disclosed compound is preferred. However, the combination therapy
can also be administered on overlapping schedules. It is also envisioned that the
combination of one or more active ingredients and a disclosed compound can be
more efficacious than either as a single agent.
Examples of disorders associated with a histone demethylase
dysfunction include a disorder of uncontrolled cellular proliferation. In a yet further
aspect, the disorder of uncontrolled cellular proliferation is cancer. In a yet further
aspect, the cancer is a leukemia. In an even further aspect, the cancer is a
sarcoma. In a still further aspect, the cancer is a solid tumor. In a yet further
aspect, the cancer is a lymphoma.
It is understood that cancer refer to or describe the physiological
condition in mammals that is typically characterized by unregulated cell growth. The
cancer may be multi-drug resistant (MDR) or drug-sensitive. Examples of cancer
include but are not limited to, carcinoma, lymphoma, blastoma, sarcoma, and
leukemia. More particular examples of such cancers include breast cancer, prostate
cancer, colon cancer, squamous cell cancer, small-cell lung cancer, non-small cell
lung cancer, gastrointestinal cancer, pancreatic cancer, cervical cancer, ovarian
cancer, peritoneal cancer, liver cancer, e.g., hepatic carcinoma, bladder cancer,
colorectal cancer, endometrial carcinoma, kidney cancer, and thyroid cancer.
In various aspects, further examples of cancers are basal cell
carcinoma, biliary tract cancer; bone cancer; brain and CNS cancer;
choriocarcinoma; connective tissue cancer; esophageal cancer; eye cancer; cancer
of the head and neck; gastric cancer; intra-epithelial neoplasm; larynx cancer;
— 66 —
lymphoma including Hodgkin‘s and Non-Hodgkin‘s lymphoma; melanoma; myeloma;
neuroblastoma; oral cavity cancer (e.g., lip, tongue, mouth, and pharynx);
retinoblastoma; rhabdomyosarcoma; rectal cancer; cancer of the respiratory system;
sarcoma; skin cancer; stomach cancer; testicular cancer; uterine cancer; cancer of
the urinary system, as well as other carcinomas and sarcomas
In a further aspect, the cancer is a hematological cancer. In a still
further aspect, the hematological cancer is selected from acute myeloid leukemia
(AML), acute lymphoblastic leukemia (ALL), chronic myeloid leukemia (CML),
chronic lymphocytic leukemia (CLL), hairy cell leukemia, chronic myelomonocytic
leukemia (CMML), juvenile myelomonocytic leukemia (JMML), Hodgkin lymphoma,
Non-Hodgkin lymphoma, multiple myeloma, solitary myeloma, localized myeloma,
and extramedullary myeloma. In a still further aspect, the cancer is selected from
chronic lymphocytic leukemia, small lymphocytic lymphoma, B-cell non-Hodgkin
lymphoma, and large B-cell lymphoma.
In a further aspect, the cancer is a cancer of the brain. In a still further
aspect, the cancer of the brain is selected from a glioma, medulloblastoma, primitive
neuroectodermal tumor (PNET), acoustic neuroma, glioma, meningioma, pituitary
adenoma, schwannoma, CNS lymphoma, primitive neuroectodermal tumor,
craniopharyngioma, chordoma, medulloblastoma, cerebral neuroblastoma, central
neurocytoma, pineocytoma, pineoblastoma, atypical teratoid rhabdoid tumor,
chondrosarcoma, chondroma, choroid plexus carcinoma, choroid plexus papilloma,
craniopharyngioma, dysembryoplastic neuroepithelial tumor, gangliocytoma,
germinoma, hemangioblastoma, hemangiopercytoma, and metastatic brain tumor.
In a yet further aspect, the glioma is selected from ependymoma, astrocytoma,
oligodendroglioma, and oligoastrocytoma. In an even further aspect, the glioma is
selected from juvenile pilocytic astrocytoma, subependymal giant cell astrocytoma,
ganglioglioma, subependymoma, pleomorphic xanthoastrocytom, anaplastic
astrocytoma, glioblastoma multiforme, brain stem glioma, oligodendroglioma,
ependymoma, oligoastrocytoma, cerebellar astrocytoma, desmoplastic infantile
astrocytoma, subependymal giant cell astrocytoma, diffuse astrocytoma, mixed
glioma, optic glioma, gliomatosis cerebri, multifocal gliomatous tumor, multicentric
glioblastoma multiforme tumor, paraganglioma, and ganglioglioma.
— 67 —
In one aspect, the cancer can be a cancer selected from cancers of
the blood, brain, genitourinary tract, gastrointestinal tract, colon, rectum, breast,
kidney, lymphatic system, stomach, lung, pancreas, and skin. In a further aspect,
the cancer is selected from prostate cancer, glioblastoma multiforme, endometrial
cancer, breast cancer, and colon cancer. In a further aspect, the cancer is selected
from a cancer of the breast, ovary, prostate, head, neck, and kidney. In a still further
aspect, the cancer is selected from cancers of the blood, brain, genitourinary tract,
gastrointestinal tract, colon, rectum, breast, livery, kidney, lymphatic system,
stomach, lung, pancreas, and skin. In a yet further aspect, the cancer is selected
from a cancer of the lung and liver. In an even further aspect, the cancer is selected
from a cancer of the breast, ovary, testes and prostate In a still further aspect, the
cancer is a cancer of the breast. In a yet further aspect, the cancer is a cancer of
the ovary. In an even further aspect, the cancer is a cancer of the prostate. In a still
further aspect, the cancer is a cancer of the testes.
In various aspects, disorders associated with a histone demethylase
dysfunction include neurodegenerative disorders. In a further aspect, the
neurodegenerative disease is selected from Alzheimer‘s disease, Parkinson‘s
disease, and Huntington‘s disease.
The compounds are further useful in a method for the prevention,
treatment, control, amelioration, or reducation of risk of the diseases, disorders and
conditions noted herein. The compounds are further useful in a method for the
prevention, treatment, control, amelioration, or reduction of risk of the
aforementioned diseases, disorders and conditions in combination with other
agents.
Also described is the administration of a LSD inhibitor for improving
treatment outcomes in the context of disorders of uncontrolled cellular proliferation,
including cancer. That is, in one aspect, described is a cotherapeutic method
comprising the step of administering to a mammal an effective amount and dosage
of at least one compound described herein in connection with cancer therapy.
In a further aspect, adminstration improves treatment outcomes in the
context of cancer therapy. Adminstration in connection with cancer therapy can be
— 68 —
continuous or intermittent. Adminstration need not be simultaneous with therapy and
can be before, during, and/or after therapy. For example, cancer therapy can be
provided within 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7 days before or after administration of the
compound. As a further example, cancer therapy can be provided within 1, 2, 3, or 4
weeks before or after administration of the compound. As a still further example,
cognitive or behavioral therapy can be provided before or after administration within
a period of time of 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10 half-lives of the administered
compound.
In one aspect, the disclosed compounds can be used in combination
with one or more other drugs in the treatment, prevention, control, amelioration, or
reduction of risk of diseases or conditions for which disclosed compounds or the
other drugs can have utility, where the combination of the drugs together are safer or
more effective than either drug alone. Such other drug(s) can be administered, by a
route and in an amount commonly used therefor, contemporaneously or sequentially
with a compound described herein. When a compound odescribed herein is used
contemporaneously with one or more other drugs, a pharmaceutical composition in
unit dosage form containing such other drugs and a disclosed compound is
preferred. However, the combination therapy can also include therapies in which a
disclosed compound and one or more other drugs are administered on different
overlapping schedules. It is also contemplated that when used in combination with
one or more other active ingredients, the disclosed compounds and the other active
ingredients can be used in lower doses than when each is used singly.
Accordingly, the pharmaceutical compositions include those that
contain one or more other active ingredients, in addition to a compound described
herein.
The above combinations include combinations of a disclosed
compound not only with one other active compound, but also with two or more other
active compounds. Likewise, disclosed compounds can be used in combination with
other drugs that are used in the prevention, treatment, control, amelioration, or
reduction of risk of the diseases or conditions for which disclosed compounds are
useful. Such other drugs can be administered, by a route and in an amount
commonly used therefor, contemporaneously or sequentially with a compound
— 69 —
described herein. When a compound described herein is used contemporaneously
with one or more other drugs, a pharmaceutical composition containing such other
drugs in addition to a disclosed compound is preferred. Accordingly, the
pharmaceutical compositions include those that also contain one or more other
active ingredients, in addition to a compound described herein.
The weight ratio of a disclosed compound to the second active
ingredient can be varied and will depend upon the effective dose of each ingredient.
Generally, an effective dose of each will be used. Thus, for example, when a
compound described herein is combined with another agent, the weight ratio of a
disclosed compound to the other agent will generally range from about 1000:1 to
about 1;1000, preferably about 200:1 to about 1:200. Combinations of a compound
described herein and other active ingredients will generally also be within the
aforementioned range, but in each case, an effective dose of each active ingredient
should be used.
In such combinations a disclosed compound and other active agents
can be administered separately or in conjunction. In addition, the administration of
one element can be prior to, concurrent to, or subsequent to the administration of
other agent(s).
Accordingly, the subject compounds can be used alone or in
combination with other agents which are known to be beneficial in the subject
indications or other drugs that affect receptors or enzymes that either increase the
efficacy, safety, convenience, or reduce unwanted side effects or toxicity of the
disclosed compounds. The subject compound and the other agent can be
coadministered, either in concomitant therapy or in a fixed combination.
In one aspect, the compound can be employed in combination with
anti-cancer therapeutic agents or other known therapeutic agents.
In the treatment of conditions which require inhibition or negative
modulation of LSD, an appropriate dosage level will generally be about 0.01 to 1000
mg per kg patient body weight per day which can be administered in single or
multiple doses. Preferably, the dosage level will be about 0.1 to about 250 mg/kg per
— 70 —
day; more preferably about 0.5 to about 100 mg/kg per day. A suitable dosage level
can be about 0.01 to 250 mg/kg per day, about 0.05 to 100 mg/kg per day, or about
0.1 to 50 mg/kg per day. Within this range the dosage can be 0.05 to 0.5, 0.5 to 5 or
to 50 mg/kg per day. For oral administration, the compositions are preferably
provided in the form of tablets containing 1.0 to 1000 milligrams of the active
ingredient, particularly 1.0, 5.0, 10, 15, 20, 25, 50, 75, 100, 150, 200, 250, 300, 400,
500, 600, 750, 800, 900, and 1000 milligrams of the active ingredient for the
symptomatic adjustment of the dosage to the patient to be treated. The compounds
can be administered on a regimen of 1 to 4 times per day, preferably once or twice
per day. This dosage regimen can be adjusted to provide the optimal therapeutic
response. It will be understood, however, that the specific dose level and frequency
of dosage for any particular patient can be varied and will depend upon a variety of
factors including the activity of the specific compound employed, the metabolic
stability and length of action of that compound, the age, body weight, general health,
sex, diet, mode and time of administration, rate of excretion, drug combination, the
severity of the particular condition, and the host undergoing therapy.
Also described are methods for inhibiting or negatively modulating LSD
in at least one cell, comprising the step of contacting the at least one cell with at
least one compound of the invention, in an amount effective to modulate or activate
LSD activity response, e.g. LSD1 or LSD2, in the at least one cell. In a further
aspect, the cell is mammalian, for example human. In a further aspect, the cell has
been isolated from a subject prior to the contacting step. In a further aspect,
contacting is via administration to a subject.
a. TREATMENT OF A DISORDER OF UNCONTROLLED CELLULAR
PROLIFERATION
Also described is a method for the treatment of a disorder of
uncontrolled cellular proliferation in a mammal, the method comprising the step of
administering to the mammal an effective amount of least one disclosed compound
or a product of a disclosed method of making a compound, or a pharmaceutically
acceptable salt, hydrate, solvate, or polymorph thereof, thereby treating the disorder
of uncontrolled cellular proliferation.
— 71 —
In a still further aspect, the effective amount is a therapeutically
effective amount. In a yet still further aspect, the effective amount is a
prophylactically effective amount.
In a further aspect, the mammal is a human. In a yet further aspect,
the method further comprises the step of identifying a mammal in need of treatment
of a disorder of uncontrolled cellular proliferation. In a still further aspect, the
mammal has been diagnosed with a need for treatment of a disorder of uncontrolled
cellular proliferation prior to the administering step.
In a further aspect, the disorder of uncontrolled cellular proliferation is
associated with a histone demethylase dysfunction. In a further aspect, the histone
demethylase is a lysine-specific histone demethylase. In a yet further aspect, the
lysine-specific histone demethylase is LSD1. In an even further aspect, the lysine-
specific histone demethylase is LSD2.
In a further aspect, the disorder of uncontrolled cellular proliferation is
a cancer. In a yet further aspect, the cancer is a leukemia. In an even further
aspect, the cancer is a sarcoma. In a still further aspect, the cancer is a solid tumor.
In a yet further aspect, the cancer is a lymphoma. In an even further aspect, the
cancer is selected from chronic lymphocytic leukemia, small lymphocytic lymphoma,
B-cell non-Hodgkin lymphoma, and large B-cell lymphoma. In a still further aspect,
the cancer is selected from cancers of the blood, brain, genitourinary tract,
gastrointestinal tract, colon, rectum, breast, livery, kidney, lymphatic system,
stomach, lung, pancreas, and skin. In a yet further aspect, the cancer is selected
from a cancer of the lung and liver. In an even further aspect, the cancer is selected
from a cancer of the breast, ovary, testes and prostate. In a still further aspect, the
cancer is a cancer of the breast. In a yet further aspect, the cancer is a cancer of
the ovary. In an even further aspect, the cancer is a cancer of the prostate. In a still
further aspect, the cancer is a cancer of the testes.
b. DECREASING HISTONE DEMETHYLASE ACTIVITY
Also described is a method for decreasing histone demethylase activity
in a mammal, the method comprising the step of administering to the mammal an
— 72 —
effective amount of at least one disclosed compound or a product of a disclosed
method of making a compound, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, hydrate,
solvate, or polymorph thereof, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, hydrate,
solvate, or polymorph thereof, thereby decreasing histone demethylase activity in
the mammal.
In a still further aspect, the effective amount is a therapeutically
effective amount. In a yet still further aspect, the effective amount is a
prophylactically effective amount.
In a further aspect, the mammal is a human. In a yet further aspect,
the method further comprises the step of identifying a mammal in need of
decreasing histone demethylase activity. In a still further aspect, the mammal has
been diagnosed with a need for decreasing histone demethylase activity prior to the
administering step.
In a further aspect, the histone demethylase is a lysine-specific histone
demethylase. In a yet further aspect, the lysine-specific histone demethylase is
LSD1. In an even further aspect, the lysine-specific histone demethylase is LSD2.
In a further aspect, the need for decreasing histone demethylase
activity is associated with a histone demethylase dysfunction. In a yet further
aspect, the histone demethylase dysfunction is associated with a disorder of
uncontrolled cellular proliferation. In a yet further aspect, the method further
comprises the step of identifying a mammal in need of treating a disorder of
uncontrolled cellular proliferation. In a still further aspect, the mammal has been
diagnosed with a need for treating a disorder of uncontrolled cellular proliferation
prior to the administering step.
In a still further aspect, the disorder of uncontrolled cellular proliferation
is a cancer. In a yet further aspect, the cancer is a leukemia. In an even further
aspect, the cancer is a sarcoma. In a still further aspect, the cancer is a solid tumor.
In a yet further aspect, the cancer is a lymphoma. In an even further aspect, the
cancer is selected from chronic lymphocytic leukemia, small lymphocytic lymphoma,
B-cell non-Hodgkin lymphoma, and large B-cell lymphoma. In a still further aspect,
— 73 —
the cancer is selected from cancers of the blood, brain, genitourinary tract,
gastrointestinal tract, colon, rectum, breast, livery, kidney, lymphatic system,
stomach, lung, pancreas, and skin. In a yet further aspect, the cancer is selected
from a cancer of the lung and liver. In an even further aspect, the cancer is selected
from a cancer of the breast, ovary, testes and prostate. In a still further aspect, the
cancer is a cancer of the breast. In a yet further aspect, the cancer is a cancer of
the ovary. In an even further aspect, the cancer is a cancer of the prostate. In a still
further aspect, the cancer is a cancer of the testes.
c. DECREASING HISTONE DEMETHYLASE ACTIVITY IN CELLS
Also described is a method for decreasing histone demethylase activity
in at least one cell, the method comprising the step of contacting the at least one cell
with an effective amount of least one disclosed compound or a product of a
disclosed method of making a compound, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt,
hydrate, solvate, or polymorph thereof, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt,
hydrate, solvate, or polymorph thereof, thereby decreasing histone demethylase
activity in the cell.
In a still further aspect, the effective amount is a therapeutically
effective amount. In a yet still further aspect, the effective amount is a
prophylactically effective amount.
In a further aspect, the cell is mammalian. In a still further aspect, the
cell is human. In a yet further aspect, contacting is via administration to a mammal.
In a further aspect, the method further comprises the step of identifying the mammal
as having a need of decreasing histone demethylase activity in a cell. In a still
further aspect, the mammal has been diagnosed with a need for decreasing histone
demethylase activity prior to the administering step.
In a further aspect, the histone demethylase is a lysine-specific histone
demethylase. In a yet further aspect, the lysine-specific histone demethylase is
LSD1. In an even further aspect, the lysine-specific histone demethylase is LSD2.
In a further aspect, the need for decreasing histone demethylase
activity in a cell is associated with a disorder of uncontrolled cellular. In a still further
— 74 —
aspect, the disorder of uncontrolled cellular proliferation is a cancer. In a yet further
aspect, the cancer is a leukemia. In an even further aspect, the cancer is a
sarcoma. In a still further aspect, the cancer is a solid tumor. In a yet further
aspect, the cancer is a lymphoma. In an even further aspect, the cancer is selected
from chronic lymphocytic leukemia, small lymphocytic lymphoma, B-cell non-
Hodgkin lymphoma, and large B-cell lymphoma. In a still further aspect, the cancer
is selected from cancers of the blood, brain, genitourinary tract, gastrointestinal tract,
colon, rectum, breast, livery, kidney, lymphatic system, stomach, lung, pancreas,
and skin. In a yet further aspect, the cancer is selected from a cancer of the lung
and liver. In an even further aspect, the cancer is selected from a cancer of the
breast, ovary, testes and prostate. In a still further aspect, the cancer is a cancer of
the breast. In a yet further aspect, the cancer is a cancer of the ovary. In an even
further aspect, the cancer is a cancer of the prostate. In a still further aspect, the
cancer is a cancer of the testes.
2. MANUFACTURE OF A MEDICAMENT
Also described is a method for the manufacture of a medicament for
inhibition of histone demethylase activity in a mammal comprising combining a
therapeutically effective amount of a disclosed compound or product of a disclosed
method with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier or diluent.
F. EXPERIMENTAL
The following examples are put forth so as to provide those of ordinary
skill in the art with a complete disclosure and description of how the compounds,
compositions, articles, devices and/or methods claimed herein are made and
evaluated, and are intended to be purely exemplary of the invention and are not
intended to limit the scope of what the inventors regard as their invention. Efforts
have been made to ensure accuracy with respect to numbers (e.g., amounts,
temperature, etc.), but some errors and deviations should be accounted for. Unless
indicated otherwise, parts are parts by weight, temperature is in C or is at ambient
temperature, and pressure is at or near atmospheric.
— 75 —
Several methods for preparing the compounds of this invention are
illustrated in the following Examples. Starting materials and the requisite
intermediates are in some cases commercially available, or can be prepared
according to literature procedures or as illustrated herein.
The following exemplary compounds of the invention were
synthesized. The Examples are provided herein to illustrate the invention, and
should not be construed as limiting the invention in any way. The Examples are
typically depicted in free base form, according to the IUPAC naming convention.
However, some of the Examples were obtained or isolated in salt form.
As indicated, some of the Examples were obtained as racemic
mixtures of one or more enantiomers or diastereomers. The compounds may be
separated by one skilled in the art to isolate individual enantiomers. Separation can
be carried out by the coupling of a racemic mixture of compounds to an
enantiomerically pure compound to form a diastereomeric mixture, followed by
separation of the individual diastereomers by standard methods, such as fractional
crystallization or chromatography. A racemic or diastereomeric mixture of the
compounds can also be separated directly by chromatographic methods using chiral
stationary phases.
1. GENERAL CHEMICAL MATERIALS AND METHODS
All analytical or anhydrous grade reagents were purchased from
commercial sources and were used without further purification. Solvents were of
analytical or anhydrous grade (Sigma-Aldrich). Specialty chemicals and building
blocks obtained from several suppliers were of the highest offered purity (always ≥
95%).
NMR spectroscopy was performed on a Varian Unity 400 instrument
with a 5 mm broadband probe and using standard pulse sequences. Chemical shifts
(δ) are reported in parts-per-million (ppm) downfield from solvent references.
Coupling constants (J-values) are expressed in Hz.
Mass spectrometry was performed on a Finnigan LCQ Duo LCMS ion
trap electrospray (ESI) mass spectrometer. All samples were analyzed by positive
— 76 —
ESI-MS and the mass-to-charge ratio (m/z) of the protonated molecular ion is
reported.
Microwave-assisted reactions were performed on a Biotage Initiator 2.5
at various powers.
Hydrogenation reactions were performed on a standard Parr
hydrogenation apparatus.
Reactions were monitored either by HPLC or TLC. When monitored
by TLC, reactions were analyzed on Baker flexible-backed plates coated with 200
µm of silica gel containing a fluorescent indicator. Preparative TLC was performed
on 20 cm x 20 cm Analtech Uniplates coated with a 1000 or 2000 µm silica gel layer
containing a fluorescent (UV 254) indicator. Elution mixtures are reported as v:v.
Spot visualization was achieved using UV light.
Flash chromatography was performed on a Teledyne Isco CombiFlash
RF 200 using appropriately sized Redisep Rf Gold or Standard normal-phase silica
or reversed-phase C-18 columns. Crude compounds were adsorbed on silica gel,
70-230 mesh 40 Å (for normal phase) or Celite 503 (for reversed-phase) and loaded
into solid cartridges. Elution mixtures are reported as v:v.
2. MOLECULAR MODELING AND VIRTUAL SCREENING METHODS
All computational studies employed PDB ID 2Z5U for the structural
coordinates of LSD1. Virtual docking methods ICM, Glide and GOLD programs were
implemented. The protein structure was prepared by 3D protonation, deletion of
water molecules and energy minimization using the ICM force field and distance-
dependent dielectric potential with an RMS gradient of 0.1; heavy atoms in the
protein were kept fixed, and histidine residues were considered as neutral. Virtual
screening calculations utilized default parameters (unless explicitly specified
otherwise) with ICM and Glide scores as scoring functions respectively. In both
cases, FAD was defined as the ligand and an active site region was defined by a
sphere of radius 12 Å around the bound FAD in complex with LSD1.
— 77 —
Confirmation of the accuracy and efficiency of the applied docking
protocol used the FAD cofactor adenine dinucleotide fragment, and the flavin
fragment, and known LSD1 inhibitors (decoy set) as positive controls. Two separate
docking runs were carried out with ICM and the Glide docking program; GOLD
docking was employed for re-scoring.
The compound database was prepared using Ligprep 2.1.23
(Schrödinger, LLC., New York, New York). Two rounds of VS, including HTVS and
standard precision (SP) docking, were adopted. The top 10000 compounds ranked
by Glide were stored and submitted for additional docking experiments using ICM
docking. The final set of 2000 hits was selected based on ICM scores and individual
compounds were visually inspected to check the docking poses and interactions
between ligands and LSD1. GOLD consensus scoring functions were employed
further to re-score these 2000 hits selected from Glide and ICM. Finally, 121
compounds were purchased (if available) or synthesized for LSD1 inhibition studies.
3. MD SIMULATION METHODS
All simulations were performed using the AMBER ff99SB force field
(Hornak, V., et al. Proteins 2006, 65 (3), 712-25) for LSD1, the general Amber force
field (―gaff‖; see Wang, J., et al. J Comput Chem 2004, 25 (9), 1157-74) for
compound 12, and the TIP3P (Jorgensen, W. L., Journal of Chemical Physics 1982,
(77), 4156-4163) model for water was employed. The simulations approximated
long-range electrostatic interactions using the particle-mesh Ewald method (PME)
procedure (Essmann, U., et al. Journal of Chemical Physics 1995, (103), 8577-
8593; Darden, T., et al. Journal of Chemical Physics 1993, (98), 10089-10092).
Using LEaP the binding modes generated from ICM docking in complex with LSD1
were solvated to neutral charge and the complexes were first minimized with
PMEMD (Case, D. A., et al. AMBER11, San Francisco, 2010). Following
minimization, 200 ps of unrestrained molecular dynamics simulation using a non-
bonded interaction cutoff of 9Å was run for both binding modes with a constant
pressure periodic boundary maintaining 1 atm of pressure and isotropic position
scaling with a relaxation time of 2 ps. SHAKE was used to constrain bonds involving
hydrogen and Langevin dynamics were used to regulate temperature (Case, D. A.,
— 78 —
et al. AMBER11, San Francisco, 2010), maintaining 300 K. Relative free energies of
binding for comparisons between the two binding modes were predicted using
MMPBSA.py with 100 snapshots at 1-ps intervals starting either at 1ps or 101ps
into the trajectory.
4. VIRTUAL SCREENING RESULTS
The first crystal structures of LSD1 elucidating critical architectural
features were later by Stavropoulos et al. (Nat Struct Mol Biol 2006, 13(7):626-32;
Protein Data Bank or PDB ID 2H94; see http://www.wwpdb.org/), Yang et al.(Mol
Cell 2006, 23 (3), 377-87; PDB ID 2IW5), and Chen et al. (Proc Natl Acad Sci USA
2006, 103 (38), 13956-61; PDB ID 2HKO). These 2.9 Å, 2.57 Å, and 2.8 Å
structures, respectively, show a highly negatively charged substrate-binding cavity
spacious enough to accommodate the N-terminal tail of histone H3. Further, an N-
terminal SWIRM domain and an insertion in the core catalytic domain, termed the
Tower Domain, were established as necessary structural motifs for enzymatic
activity and interactions with cofactors such as CoREST. For the studies described
herein, the structure, PDB ID 2Z5U, was used with bound LSD1 inhibitor
tranylcypromine for computational studies, including virtual screening, docking, and
molecular dynamics (Mimasu, S., et al. Biochem Biophys Res Commun 2008, 366
(1), 15-22). In order to evaluate the chemical space outside of tranylcypromine and
polyamine derivatives, HTVS was used with an in-house library. The library was
curated from publicly available vendor libraries, totaling approximately 13 million
compounds, using custom filters developed in-house. Compounds were filtered
based on Lipinski‘s rule of five, with exceptions occurring in only 62,000 compounds.
Further, structurally redundant compounds were removed such that the resulting
library contained a diverse, yet manageable set of about 2 million compounds. Prior
to screening, compounds were prepared using the LigPrep module of the
Schrodinger Suite as well as ICM‘s inbuilt preparation of three-dimensional (3D)
ligands such that physiologically relevant protonation states were used.
Prepared ligands were then docked against three different sites on
LSD1; the FAD site located in the amine oxidase domain, and the adenine
dinucleotide and flavin fragments of this pocket. The docking protocols used by both
ICM and Glide were run with the FAD, adenine dinucleotide, flavin fragments, and
— 79 —
known LSD1 inhibitors to check for accuracy. In addition to the docking algorithm
rankings, visual inspection of the docking results was used to evaluate binding
position, suitable pose, and orientation. Taken together, the scoring functions from
ICM and Glide were able to correctly identify known inhibitors within the top 2% of
the decoy set used. GOLD was used to re-score and the GOLD fitness function
produced similar enrichments.
A virtual screen was set up against the FAD- binding pocket of LSD1
using the established docking protocol and the 2 million-compound database. The
top 10,000 compounds were selected from both ICM and Glide scoring functions for
further analysis. A few identical compounds were scored similarly between the two
algorithms; this redundancy was filtered out. Furthermore, visual inspection was
performed to filter out similar compounds and to increase the diversity of the final
selection. Visual analysis also allowed identificatin of key interactions within the
FAD-binding pocked of LSD1. These include hydrogen bonding with Ser289, Arg310
and Arg316, van der Waals interactions with Val590 and Leu625, and π interactions
with Trp756. Moreover, compounds with hydroxyl and hydrophobic electron
withdrawing groups seemed to show increased enrichment in the initial docking
results. The FAD-binding pocket of LSD1 is a deep and narrow crevice in the interior
of the protein and is surrounded by hydrophobic amino acid residues. Thus the
hydrophobic character of the compounds may play an important role in the random
walk of the compound into the active site.
Based on the selection criteria discussed above, 121 structurally
distinct compounds were procured and submitted for biochemical screening against
LSD1. The biochemical assay, as described in the experimental section, measures
H O produced from the oxidative demethylation of a peptide substrate. From the
121 compounds, a series of related compounds, which showed potent activity in the
biochemical assay, were identified. Docking scores, ranks, and accompanying
biochemical assay results for the series are presented in Tables 1, 2, and 6-9.
Of the ten active compounds in Table 1 (and associated tables
providing biochemical and cellular data, Tables 6, 8, and 9), that were discovered
using virtual screening methods, e.g. compounds 1, 2, 4 and 5 showed similar
binding modes within the FAD-binding site of LSD1. Additionally, the docking scores
— 80 —
for compounds 1, 2, 4 and 5 correlated well with the observed biochemical activity.
These results suggested that improved inhibitors targeted toward the adenine
dinucleotide pocket in the amine oxidase domain of LSD1 were accessible.
The Glide scores are predictive and correlated well with compounds
having p-OH or m-Cl aryl substitutions (compounds 1 and 5). It is clear from these
studies that the hydrophobic electron withdrawing groups such as –Cl are tolerated,
whereas small alkyl substituents such as methyl (e.g. compound 8) or fused bicyclic
containing compound 10 have lower activity. Introduction of any donating groups
particularly the -OCH functional group at the 2 position lost activity due to lack of
Gly314 H-bonding interactions (e.g. compound 6). The lack of biochemical activity of
compound 6 was highly predictive from docking scores, where ICM and Glide
provided -18.39 and -6.63 kcal/mol energies respectively. In subsequent docking
analysis, additional benzohydrazine series of compounds were identified, with
hydrazine –C methyl or aryl 4-substituted sulfone containing compounds, as
exemplified by the virtual hit compound 9, which exhibited potent LSD1 inhibition
activity with an IC of 19 nM. The low docking score of compound 9 is primarily due
to the shift in 2-OH aryl ring position. Compound 9, with a sulfone/morpholine
substituent, was chosen as a backbone for further optimization due, in part, to its
chemical stability.
The binding mode of compound 12 with the sulfone/morpholine is
depicted with the docking pose predicted from ICM in Figure 1. In this model, the
phenolic group fits well in the pocket composed of residues Ser289, Gly314 and
Arg316. The central carbonyl group appears to be involved in strong H-bonding
interactions with Arg310 amino group and the morpholine oxygen shows H-bonding
interactions with Val590. These sets of hydrogen bonding interactions were also
observed with Glide and GOLD docking experiments. The additional experiments
showed the morpholine substituted aryl ring participating in π-π interactions with
Trp756 residue while the morpholine oxygen retained in H-bonding with Val590.
Chemical optimization also focused on the design of compounds
containing heteroaryl rings on either side of compound 12. Computational models
using these results generated a variety of chemically plausible scaffolds, from which
a substituted pyridine was identified as being an appropriate moiety capable of
— 81 —
interacting with Ser289, Gly314 and Arg316, surrounding residues and ideal
properties. A representative is compound 24, which had potent LSD1 activity of (28
nM) and also exhibited a similar binding mode to that of compound 12 (see Figure
Many of the representative compounds contain a C-alkyl hydrazine to
increase metabolic stability of the series. However, a bulkier group, like the ethyl
group of compound 21, isn‘t well accommodated by the binding pocket as illustrated
in different biochemical activities of compounds 12 and 21. Aryl substitiution with
methylsulfone (compound 25) and substituted with a morpholine ring (compound 12)
increased biochemical efficacy by roughly an order of magnitude when compared to
compound 11. Addition of only a morpholine ring maintains some biochemical
activity as illustrated by compound 23. Replacing the sulfono-morpholine with
sulfono-N-dimethyl also maintained biochemical activity as illustrated by compound
18. Additionally, replacement of the 2-OH group with a chloro was found not to be
well accommodated and a significant drop in activity was demonstrated between
compounds 12 and 16. Results with compound 24 suggest that using a substituted
pyridine is accommodated by the enzyme, but various other substitutions and
heterocycles generally resulted in a drop in biochemical activity as illustrated in
compounds 13, 14, 15, 17, 19, 20 and 22.
Many of the representative compounds in Table 2 contained a C-alkyl
hydrazine to increase metabolic stability of the series. However, a bulkier group,
e.g. the ethyl group of compound 21, is less well accommodated by the binding
pocket as illustrated in the different biochemical activities of compounds 12 and 21.
The aryl substitiution with methylsulfone (e.g. compound 25) and substituted with a
morpholine ring (compound 12) increased biochemical efficacy by roughly an order
of magnitude when compared to compound 11. Addition of a heterocycle, e.g. a
morpholine ring, maintains biochemical activity as illustrated by compound 23.
Replacing the sulfono-morpholine with sulfono-N-dimethyl also maintained
biochemical activity as illustrated by compound 18. Additionally, replacement of the
2-OH group with a chloro was found not to be accommodated with a significant drop
in activity between compounds 12 and 16. As discussed above, compound 24
suggests that using a substituted pyridine is accommodated by the enzyme. Further
— 82 —
analysis suggests that the hydroxyl of compound 12 is associated with increased
biochemical activity, e.g. when this substituent group is substituted with a chlorine
(compound 16), activity was decreaased.
TABLE 1.
No. Structure ICM Glide Gold
Score Score Fitness
1 -42.25 -8.14 56.26
-42.25 -7.92 58.21
3 -21.91 -7.87 51.29
4 -37.77 -8.64 57.69
-36.3 -8.84 47.98
6 -18.39 -6.63 49.93
-8.16 -7.21 41.86
8 -8.5 -6.81 52.19
— 83 —
No. Structure ICM Glide Gold
Score Score Fitness
-24 -6.26 43.26
-20.97 -6.14 46.64
TABLE 2.
No. Structure ICM Glide Gold
Score Score Fitness
11 -29.76 -7.89 58.21
-38.16 -8.96 58.17
13 -36.14 -9.21 54.88
14 -23.81 -6.75 46.21
-31.24 -7.91 51.29
16 -41.26 -6.87 53.29
— 84 —
No. Structure ICM Glide Gold
Score Score Fitness
-29.23 -7.93 43.29
18 -41.96 -9.87 53.92
19 -27.24 -6.87 43.76
-21.41 -6.28 37.28
21 -23.11 -7.21 39.84
-19.88 -6.97 37.24
23 -38.11 -8.21 46.81
24 -37.11 -9.23 51.65
-39.14 -8.21 49.11
— 85 —
. MOLECULAR DYNAMIC SIMULATION RESULTS
Molecular dynamice (―MD‖) simulations were carried out using the two
different docking poses of compound 12 to determine if there was a preference for
one docking pose over another. These data can better inform which interactions
play a role in the results obtained with the compounds synthesized. The docking
results show the higher ranked pose with compound 12 bound into the dinucleotide
binding pocket via direct H-bond interactions with Ser289 or Arg316 via its hydroxyl
moiety (binding mode 1, see Figure 3 and Table 3). However, there is another pose
favorably scored with the morpholine ring of compound 12 interacting with Ser289
and Arg316 (binding mode 2, see Figure 3 and Table 3).
MD using the AMBER suite was used to evaluate the energetics of
binding for both predicted binding modes. Simulations for binding mode 1 showed
π-conjugated electron interactions between compound 12 and Arg 316 as well as
potential for hydrogen bonding between the hydroxyl and Ser289. Analysis of
binding mode 2 showed potential π- π interactions between compound 12 and
Trp756 with more favorable hydrogen bonds with Arg310 and Arg316. Further,
binding mode 1 is predicted to have hydrogen bonding with Val590 while binding
mode two has van der Waals interactions involving the chloro group. MMPBSA
analysis of the final 100 ps of simulation showed that binding mode 2 was predicted
to have a free energy of binding of ~-40.8 kcal/mol, which is nearly 20 kcal/mol more
favorable than ~-21.0 for binding mode 1. The first 100 ps of simulation likely reflect
in part the equilibration of the complex such that the calculated free energies of
binding are not as favorable. This finding contrasts with the rankings of the binding
poses during the docking process. It is possible that this difference arises from
differences in the protein structure during docking and MD, with a rigid structure
used to increase the speed of the docking protocol and a flexible structure used for
TABLE 3.
MD Compound No. 12 Compound No. 12
(Binding Mode 1) (Binding Mode 2)
1-100ps: -20.2154 -32.9117
ΔG-bind (kcal/mol)
— 86 —
MD Compound No. 12 Compound No. 12
(Binding Mode 1) (Binding Mode 2)
101-200ps: -21.0263 -40.8046
ΔG-bind (kcal/mol)
150-200ps: 0.394 1.560
ligand RMSD (Å)
6. PREPARATION OF (E)-N ’-(1-(5-CHLORO
HYDROXYPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
1-(5-Chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethanone (100 mg, 0.586 mmol) and benzohydrazide
(80 mg, 0.586 mmol) were dissolved in methanol (4 mL) in the presence of acetic
acid as a catalyst, and then the reaction mixture was heated via microwave
irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. Following cooling, the solvent was removed by
vacuum, and the resulting crude material was purified by flash column
chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) affording the title compound (90 mg) as a
3 2 2
solid. H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d ): δ 7.95 (m, 2H), 7.67-7.62 (m, 2H), 7.56 (m,
2H), 7.35 (dd, 1H, J = 2.4 & 8.8 Hz), 6.95 (d, 1H, J = 8.4 Hz), 3.35 (s, 3H). ESI-MS:
289.0 [M+H] .
7. PREPARATION OF (E)-N ’-(1-(2,6-
DIHYDROXYPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
1-(2,6-Dihydroxyphenyl)ethanone (100mg, 0.657 mmol) and benzohydrazide (89
mg, 0.657 mmol) were dissolved in methanol (4 mL) in the presence of acetic acid
as a catalyst and then the reaction mixture was heated via microwave irradiation to
120 °C for 30 min. Following cooling, the solvent was removed by vacuum, and the
— 87 —
resulting crude material was purified by flash column chromatography (2%
CH OH/CH Cl ) affording the title compound (100 mg) as a solid. H NMR (400
3 2 2
MHz, CD OD): δ 7.59 (m, 2H), 7.49 (m, 1H), 7.39 (m, 2H), 7.11 (t, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz),
6.45 (m, 2H), 2.35 (s, 3H). ESI-MS: 271.1 [M+H] .
8. PREPARATION OF 3-(MORPHOLINOSULFONYL)BENZOIC ACID.
3-(Chlorosulfonyl)benzoic acid (250 mg, 1.133 mmol) was added to morpholine (99
mg, 1.133 mmol) in the presence of potassium carbonate (313 mg, 2.266 mmol) in
THF (5 mL) at room temperature, and reaction mixture allowed to stirred for 12 h at
rt. The reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, the solvent
was removed by vacuum, and then compound was purified by column
chromatography (3% CH OH/CH Cl ) affording the title compound (160 mg) as a
3 2 2
solid. H NMR (400 MHz, CD OD): δ 8.34 (m, 1H), 8.32 (d, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 7.99 (m,
1H), 7.76 (t, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 3.70 (m, 4H), 2.98 (m, 4H). ESI-MS: 272.0 [M+H] .
9. PREPARATION OF METHYL 3-(MORPHOLINOSULFONYL)BENZOATE.
3-(Morpholinosulfonyl)benzoic acid (100 mg, 0.369 mmol) was refluxed overnight in
methanol in the presence of catalytic concentrated H SO at 65 °C. The reaction
was monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, the solvent was removed
by vacuum and then compound was purified by column chromatography to yield the
title compound as an off white solid (60 mg). H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl ): δ 8.38 (t,
1H, J = 1.6 Hz), 8.27 (m, 1H), 7.92 (m, 1H), 7.64 (t, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 3.95 (s, 3H),
3.73 (m, 4H), 3.00 (m,4H). ESI-MS: 286.1 [M+H] .
— 88 —
. PREPARATION OF 3-(MORPHOLINOSULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
Methyl 3-(morpholinosulfonyl)benzoate (120 mg, 0.421 mmol) was added to
hydrazine (17.52 mg, 0.547 mmol) in methanol and refluxed for 12 h at 65 °C. The
reaction was monitored by TLC. Upon completion of the reaction and cooling the
reaction mixture, the solvent was removed by vacuum and then compound was
purified by column chromatography to yield the title compound as anoff white solid
(90 mg). H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl ): δ 8.16 (m, 1H), 8.12 (m, 1H), 8.04 (m, 1H),
7.85 (m, 1H), 7.63 (t, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 4.19 (m, 2H), 3.71 (m, 4H), 2.97 (m, 4H). ESI-
MS: 286.1 [M+H] .
11. PREPARATION OF (E)-N ’-(1-(5-CHLOROHYDROXYPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)
(MORPHOLINOSULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
1-(5-Chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethanone (20 mg, 0.117 mmol) and 3-
(morpholinosulfonyl) benzohydrazide (33.5 mg, 0.117 mmol) were dissolved in
methanol (4 mL) in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst, and the reaction
mixture was heated via microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. Following
cooling, the solvent was removed by vacuum and the resulting crude material was
purified by flash column chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) affording the title
3 2 2
compound (16 mg) as a solid. H NMR (400 MHz, CD OD): δ 8.26 (m, 1H), 8.17 (d,
1H, J = 8.0Hz), 7.92 (d, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 7.72 (t, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 7.48 (d, 1H, J = 2.0
Hz), 7.22 (m, 1H), 6.91 (d, 1H, J = 8.8 Hz), 3.72 (m, 4H), 3.01 (m, 4H), 2.43 (s, 3H).
ESI-MS: 438.1 [M+H] .
— 89 —
12. PREPARATION OF (E)-N ’-(1-(3-CHLOROFLUOROPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)
(MORPHOLINOSULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
1-(3-Chlorofluorophenyl)ethanone (20 mg, 0.116 mmol) and 3-
(morpholinosulfonyl) benzohydrazide (33.1 mg, 0.116 mmol) waere dissolved in
methanol (4 mL) in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst, and the reaction
mixture was heated via microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. Following
cooling, the solvent was removed by vacuum and the resulting crude material was
purified by flash column chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) affording the title
3 2 2
compound (22 mg) as a solid. H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl ): δ 9.43 (s, 1H), 8.37 (m,
1H), 8.16 (m, 1H), 7.87 (d, 1H, J = 7.2 Hz), 7.65 (m, 1H), 7.41 (m, 1H), 7.10 (t, 1H, J
= 8.0 Hz), 3.71 (m, 4H), 2.95 (m, 4H), 2.38 (s, 3H). ESI-MS: 440.1 [M+H] .
13. PREPARATION OF (E)-N ’-(1-(2-CHLOROPYRIDINYL)ETHYLIDENE)
(MORPHOLINOSULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
1-(2-Chloropyridinyl)ethanone (20 mg, 0.129 mmol) and 3-(morpholinosulfonyl)
benzohydrazide (36.7 mg, 0.129 mmol) were dissolved in methanol (4 mL) in the
presence of acetic acid as a catalyst, and the reaction mixture was heated via
microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. Following cooling, the solvent was
removed by vacuum and the resulting crude material was purified by flash column
chromatography affording the title compound in a 60% yield. H NMR (400 MHz,
CDCl ): δ 9.43 (m, 1H), 8.39 (m, 2H), 8.15 (d, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 7.93 (d, 1H, J = 7.6
Hz), 7.70 (t, 1H, J= 7.6 Hz), 7.52 (m, 1H), 3.73 (m, 4H), 3.02 (m, 4H), 2.35 (s, 3H).
ESI-MS: 423.1 [M+H] .
— 90 —
14. PREPARATION OF (E)- N’-(1-(2,5-DICHLOROPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)
(MORPHOLINOSULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
1-(2,5-Dichlorophenyl)ethanone (20 mg, 0.106 mmol) and 3-(morpholinosulfonyl)
benzohydrazide (30.2 mg, 0.106 mmol) were dissolved in methanol (4 mL) in the
presence of acetic acid as a catalyst, and the reaction mixture was heated via
microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. Following cooling, the solvent was
removed by vacuum and the resulting crude material was purified by flash column
chromatography affording the title compound in a 10 mg yield. H NMR (400 MHz,
CDCl ): δ 8.29 (m, 1H), 8.09 (m, 1H), 7.81 (m, 1H), 7.57 (m, 1H), 7.40 (m, 1H), 7.26
(m, 2H), 3.52 (m, 4H), 2.91 (m, 4H), 2.28 (s, 3H). ESI-MS: 456.1 [M+H] .
. PREPARATION OF METHYL 4-HYDRAZINYL
(MORPHOLINOSULFONYL)BENZOATE.
Methyl 4-fluoro(morpholinosulfonyl)benzoate (30 mg, 0.099 mmol) was added to
hydrazine (4.44 mg, 0.138 mmol) in methanol (8 mL) and refluxed for 5 h at 65 °C.
The reaction was monitored by TLC. Upon completion of the reaction and cooling,
the solvent was removed by vacuum, and the compound was purified by column
chromatography affording the title compound (20 mg). H NMR (400 MHz, CD OD):
δ 8.15 (d, 1H, J = 2.0 Hz), 8.03 (dd, 1H, J = 2.4 & 9.2 Hz), 7.48 (d, 1H, J = 9.2 Hz),
3.86 (s, 3H), 3.67 (m, 4H), 3.04 (m, 4H). ESI-MS: 316.1 [M+H] .
16. PREPARATION OF METHYL 4-FLUORO(MORPHOLINOSULFONYL)BENZOATE.
— 91 —
4-Fluoro(morpholinosulfonyl)benzoic acid (50 mg, 0.173 mmol) was refluxed
overnight in the presence of concentrated sulfuric acid (1.117 mg, 8.64 µmol) in
methanol (8 mL) at 70 °C. The reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of
the reaction, the solvent was removed by vacuum and compound was purified by
column chromatography affording the title compound (20 mg). H NMR (400 MHz,
CD OD): δ 8.42 (dd, 1H, J = 2.0 & 6.4 Hz), 8.33 (m, 1H), 7.49 (t, 1H, J = 8.8 Hz),
3.94 (s, 3H), 3.71 (m, 4H), 3.16 (m, 4H).
17. PREPARATION OF METHYL 3-BROMOCHLOROBENZOATE.
3-Bromochlorobenzoic acid (200 mg, 0.849 mmol) was refluxed in the presence
of concentrated sulfuric acid (5.49 mg, 0.042 mmol) in methanol (10 mL) at 70 °C for
overnight. The reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, the
solvent was removed by vacuum, and the compound was purified by column
chromatography affording the title compound (130 mg). H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl ):
δ 8.29 (d, 1H, J = 2.0 Hz), 7.91 (dd, 1H, J = 2.0 & 8.4 Hz), 7.52 (d, 1H, J = 8.4 Hz),
3.92 (s, 3H). ESI-MS: 250.9 [M+H] .
18. PREPARATION OF METHYL 3-(N,N-DIMETHYLSULFAMOYL)BENZOATE.
3-(N,N-Dimethylsulfamoyl)benzoic acid (200 mg, 0.872 mmol) was refluxed
overnight in the presence of concentrated sulfuric acid (5.64 mg, 0.044 mmol) in
methanol (10 mL) at 70 °C. Reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the
reaction, the solvent was removed by vacuum and then compound was purified by
column chromatography affording the title compound (125 mg). H NMR (400 MHz,
CDCl ): δ 8.42 (s, 1H), 8.27 (d, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 7.97 (d, 1H, J = 7.2 Hz), 7.65 (t, 1H,
J = 8.0 Hz), 3.96 (s, 3H), 2.74 (s, 6H). ESI-MS: 244.0 [M+H] .
— 92 —
19. PREPARATION OF 3-BROMOCHLOROBENZOHYDRAZIDE.
Methyl 3-bromochlorobenzoate (120 mg, 0.481 mmol) was added to hydrazine
(23.12 mg, 0.721 mmol) in methanol (8 mL) and refluxed for 12 h at 70 °C. Reaction
was monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, the solvent was removed by
vacuum and then compound was purified by column chromatography affording the
title compound (30 mg). H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl ): δ 8.02 (d, 1H, J = 1.6 Hz), 7.60
(dd, 1H, J = 2.0 & 8.0 Hz), 7.52 (d, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz). ESI-MS: 250.9 [M+H] .
. PREPARATION OF 3-(HYDRAZINECARBONYL)-N,N-
DIMETHYLBENZENESULFONAMIDE.
Methyl 3-(N,N-dimethylsulfamoyl)benzoate (150 mg, 0.617 mmol) was added to
hydrazine (29.6 mg, 0.925 mmol) in methanol (10 mL) and refluxed for 8 h at 65 °C.
Following cooling, the reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the
reaction, the solvent was removed by vacuum and the compound was purified by
column chromatography affording the title compound (60 mg). H NMR (400 MHz,
CDCl ): δ 8.11 (s, 1H), 8.01 (d, 1H, J = 8.4 Hz), 7.92 (d, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 7.65 (t, 1H,
J = 8.0 Hz), 2.73 (s, 6H). ESI-MS: 244.0 [M+H] .
21. PREPARATION OF (E)BROMOCHLORO- N’-(1-(5-CHLORO
HYDROXYPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
— 93 —
3-Bromochlorobenzohydrazide (30 mg, 0.120 mmol) and 1-(5-chloro
hydroxyphenyl)ethanone (20.51 mg, 0.120 mmol) were dissolved in methanol (4 mL)
in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst, and the reaction mixture was heated via
microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. The reaction was monitored by TLC.
Upon completion of the reaction and following cooling, the solvent was removed by
vacuum, and the resulting crude material was purified by flash column
chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) affording the title compound (15 mg). H NMR
3 2 2
(400 MHz, acetone-d ): δ 8.30 (s, 1H), 7.98 (d, 1H, J = 8.4 Hz), 7.73 (d, 1H, J = 8.4
Hz), 7.61 (d, 1H, J = 2.4 Hz), 7.29 (dd, 1H, J = 2.4 & 8.4 Hz), 6.93 (d, 1H, J = 8.8
Hz), 2.55 (s, 3H). ESI-MS: 402.9 [M+H] .
22. PREPARATION OF (E)(2-(1-(5-CHLORO
HYDROXYPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)HYDRAZINECARBONYL)-N,N-
DIMETHYLBENZENESULFON- AMIDE.
3-(Hydrazinecarbonyl)-N,N-dimethylbenzenesulfonamide (50 mg, 0.206 mmol) and
1-(5-chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethanone (35.1 mg, 0.206 mmol) were dissolved in
methanol (4 mL) in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst, and the reaction
mixture was heated via microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. The reaction was
monitored by TLC. Upon completion of the reaction and following cooling, the
solvent was removed by vacuum, and the resulting crude material was purified by
flash column chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) affording the title compound as a
3 2 2
solid (15 mg). H NMR (400 MHz, acetone-d ): δ 8.29 (m, 2H), 8.01 (d, 1H, J = 8.4
Hz), 7.83 (t, 1H, J = 8.4 Hz), 7.62 (d, 1H, J = 2.4 Hz), 7.32 (dd, 1H, J = 2.4 & 8.8 Hz),
6.96 (d, 1H, J = 8.8 Hz), 2.73 (s, 6H), 2.58 (s, 3H). ESI-MS: 396.0 [M+H] .
23. PREPARATION OF 5-BROMOCHLORONICOTINOHYDRAZIDE.
— 94 —
Methyl 5-bromochloronicotinate (100 mg, 0.399 mmol) was added to hydrazine
(19.19 mg, 0.599 mmol) in methanol (8 mL) and heated overnight at 70 °C. The
reaction was monitored by TLC. Upon completion of the reaction, the solvent was
removed by vacuum, and the compound was purified by column chromatography
affording the title compound (20 mg). H NMR (400 MHz, CD OD): δ 8.33 (d, 1H, J =
2.4 Hz), 8.01 (d, 1H, J = 2.4 Hz).
24. PREPARATION OF (E)BROMOCHLORO- N’-(1-(5-CHLORO
HYDROXYPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)NICOTINOHYDRAZIDE.
-Bromochloronicotinohydrazide (15 mg, 0.060 mmol) and 1-(5-chloro
hydroxyphenyl)ethanone (10.22 mg, 0.060 mmol) were dissolved in methanol (4 mL)
in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst and the reaction mixture was heated via
microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. The reaction was monitored by TLC.
Upon completion of the reaction and following cooling, the solvent was removed by
vacuum, and the resulting crude material was purified by flash column
chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) affording the title compound as a solid (8 mg).
3 2 2
H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d ): δ 8.39 (d, 1H, J = 2.4 Hz), 8.28 (s, 1H), 7.63 (d, 1H, J
= 2.4 Hz), 7.32 (dd, 1H, J = 2.4 & 8.8 Hz), 7.06 (d, 1H, J = 6.8 Hz), 6.92 (d, 1H, J =
9.2 Hz), 6.81 (d, 1H, J = 6.8 Hz), 2.47 (s, 3H). ESI-MS: 404.0 [M+H] .
. PREPARATION OF METHYL 5-CHLORONICOTINATE.
-Chloronicotinic acid (200 mg, 1.269 mmol) was refluxed overnight in the presence
of concentrated sulfuric acid (8.20 mg, 0.063 mmol) in methanol (10 mL) at 70 °C.
The reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, the solvent
was removed by vacuum and the compound was purified by column
— 95 —
chromatography affording the title compound (120 mg). H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl ):
δ 9.07 (d, 1H, J = 1.6 Hz), 8.72 (d, 1H, J = 2.0 Hz), 8.26 (m, 1H), 3.95 (s, 1H).
26. PREPARATION OF METHYL 5-CHLORONICOTINATE
-Chloronicotinic acid (200 mg, 1.269 mmol) was refluxed overnight in the presence
of concentrated sulfuric acid (8.20 mg, 0.063 mmol) in methanol (8 mL) at 70 °C.
The reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, the solvent
was removed by vacuum and the compound was purified by column
chromatography affording the title compound (120 mg). H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl ):
δ 9.07 (d, 1H, J = 1.6 Hz), 8.72 (d, 1H, J = 2.0 Hz), 8.26 (m, 1H), 3.95 (s, 1H).
27. PREPARATION OF 5-CHLORONICOTINOHYDRAZIDE.
Hydrazine (17.93 mg, 0.560 mmol) was added to methyl 5-chloronicotinate (80 mg,
0.466 mmol) in methanol (8 mL) and heated overnight at 70 °C. The reaction was
monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, the solvent was removed by
vacuum and the compound was purified by column chromatography affording the
title compound (40 mg). H NMR (400 MHz, CD OD): δ 8.85 (d, 1H, J = 2.0 Hz), 8.70
(d, 1H, J = 2.4 Hz), 8.22 (t, 1H, J = 2.0 Hz). ESI-MS: 172.0 [M+H] .
28. PREPARATION OF (E)CHLORO- N’-(1-(5-CHLORO
HYDROXYPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)NICOTINOHYDRAZIDE.
— 96 —
-Chloronicotinohydrazide (30 mg, 0.175 mmol) and 1-(5-chloro
hydroxyphenyl)ethanone (29.8 mg, 0.175 mmol) were dissolved in methanol (4 mL)
in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst, and the reaction mixture was heated via
microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. The reaction was monitored by TLC.
Upon completion of the reaction and following cooling, the solvent was removed by
vacuum, and the resulting crude material was purified by flash column
chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) affording the title compound as a solid (20
3 2 2
mg). H NMR (400 MHz, acetone-d ): δ 9.06 (s, 1H), 8.77 (s, 1H), 8.37 (s, 1H), 7.62
(d, 1H, J = 2.8 Hz), 7.31 (dd, 1H, J = 2.0 & 8.4 Hz), 6.95 (d, 1H, J = 8.8 Hz), 2.58 (s,
3H). ESI-MS: 324.0 [M+H] .
29. PREPARATION OF (E)-N ’-(1-(5-CHLOROHYDROXYPHENYL)PROPYLIDENE)
(MORPHOLINOSULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
3-(Morpholinosulfonyl)benzohydrazide (40 mg, 0.140 mmol) and 1-(5-chloro
hydroxyphenyl)propanone (25.9 mg, 0.140 mmol) were dissolved in methanol (4
mL) in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst, and the reaction mixture was heated
via microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. The reaction was monitored by TLC.
Upon completion of the reaction and following cooling, the solvent was removed by
vacuum, and the resulting crude material was purified by flash column
chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) affording the title compound as a solid (20
3 2 2
mg). H NMR (400 MHz, acetone-d ): δ 8.26 (m, 2H), 8.00 (d, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 7.84
(t, 1H,J = 8.0 Hz), 7.64 (d, 1H, J = 2.4 Hz), 7.33 (m, 1H), 6.98 (d, 1H, J = 9.2 Hz),
3.69 (m, 4H), 3.10 (q, 2H, J = 7.6 Hz), 2.99 (m, 4H), 1.26 (t, 3H, J = 7.6 Hz). ESI-MS:
452.1 [M+H] .
— 97 —
. PREPARATION OF (E)(MORPHOLINOSULFONYL)- N’-(1-(PYRIDIN
YL)ETHYLIDENE)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
3-(Morpholinosulfonyl)benzohydrazide (40 mg, 0.140 mmol) and 1-(pyridin
yl)ethanone (16.98 mg, 0.140 mmol) were dissolved in methanol (4 mL) in the
presence of acetic acid as a catalyst, and the reaction mixture was heated via
microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. The reaction was monitored by TLC.
Upon completion of the reaction and following cooling, the solvent was removed by
vacuum, and the resulting crude material was purified by flash column
chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) affording the title compound as a solid (15
3 2 2
mg). H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl ): δ 9.53 (bs, 1H), 8.87 (s, 1H), 8.59 (m, 1H), 8.39 (m,
1H), 8.17 (m, 1H), 7.98 (m, 1H), 7.89 (d, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 7.67 (t, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz),
7.32 (m, 1H), 3.70 (m, 4H), 3.00 (m, 4H), 2.39 (s, 3H). ESI-MS: 389.0 [M+H] .
31. PREPARATION OF 3-MORPHOLINOBENZOHYDRAZIDE.
Methyl 3-morpholinobenzoate (100 mg, 0.452 mmol) was added to hydrazine (14.48
mg, 0.452 mmol) in methanol (10 mL) and refluxed for 12 h at 65 °C. The reaction
was monitored by TLC. Upon completion of the reaction and following cooling, the
solvent was removed by vacuum and the compound was purified by column
chromatography (2% CH3OH/CH Cl ) affording the title compound as a solid (52
mg). H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d ): δ 9.69 (s, 1H), 7.35 (s, 1H), 7.27 (m, 2H), 7.07
(m, 1H), 4.45 (bs, 2H), 3.74 (m, 4H), 3.14 (m, 4H). ESI-MS: 222.1 [M+H] .
— 98 —
32. PREPARATION OF (E)-N ’-(1-(5-CHLOROHYDROXYPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)
MORPHOLINOBENZOHYDRAZIDE.
1-(5-Chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethanone (40 mg, 0.234 mmol) and 3-
morpholinobenzohydrazide (51.9 mg, 0.234 mmol) were dissolved in methanol (4
mL) in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst, and the reaction mixture was heated
via microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. The reaction was monitored by TLC.
Upon completion of the reaction and following cooling, the solvent was removed by
vacuum, and the resulting crude material was purified by flash column
chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) affording the title compound (60 mg) as a
3 2 2
solid. H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d ): δ 7.65 (d, 1H, J = 2.4 Hz), 7.42-7.32 (m, 4H),
7.20 (m, 1H), 6.94 (d, 1H, J = 8.8 Hz), 3.77 (m, 4H), 3.19 (m, 4H), 2.48 (s, 3H). ESI-
MS: 374.1 [M+H] .
33. PREPARATION OF 5-(METHYLSULFONYL)NICOTINOHYDRAZIDE.
Methyl 5-(methylsulfonyl)nicotinate (100 mg, 0.465 mmol) were added to hydrazine
(17.87 mg, 0.558 mmol) in methanol (10 mL) and refluxed for 12 h at 70 °C. The
reaction was monitored by TLC. Upon completion of the reaction and following
cooling, the solvent was removed by vacuum and the compound was purified by
flash column chromatography (3% CH OH/CH Cl ) afforded the title compound (83
3 2 2
mg, 80% yield) as a solid. H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl ): δ 9.20 (d, 1H,J = 2.0 Hz), 9.17
(d, 1H, J = 2.0 Hz), 8.61 (s, 1H), 3.11 (s, 3H). ESI-MS: 216.1 [M+H] .
— 99 —
34. PREPARATION OF (E)-N ’-(1-(5-CHLOROHYDROXYPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)
(METHYLSULFONYL)NICOTINOHYDRAZIDE.
1-(5-Chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethanone (50 mg, 0.293 mmol) and 5-(methylsulfonyl)
nicotinohydrazide (63.1 mg, 0.293 mmol) were dissolved in methanol (4 mL) in the
presence of acetic acid as a catalyst, and the reaction mixture was heated via
microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. The reaction was monitored by TLC.
Upon completion of the reaction and following cooling, the solvent was removed by
vacuum, and the resulting crude material was purified by flash column
chromatography (3% CH OH/CH Cl ) affording the title compound (70 mg, 63.0%
3 2 2
yield) as a solid. H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d ): δ 11.86 (s, 1H), 9.37 (s, 1H), 9.27
(s, 1H), 8.76 (s, 1H), 7.68 (s, 1H), 7.36 (d, 1H, J = 8.8 Hz), 6.97 (d, 1H, J = 8.8 Hz),
3.42 (s, 3H), 2.53 (s, 3H). ESI-MS: 368.8 [M+H] .
. PREPARATION OF 3-(METHYLSULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
Methyl 3-(methylsulfonyl)benzoate (100 mg, 0.467 mmol) was added to hydrazine
(22.44mg, 0.700 mmol) ) in methanol (10 mL) and refluxed for 12 h at 70 °C. The
reaction was monitored by TLC. Upon completion of the reaction and following
cooling, the solvent was removed by vacuum, and the compound was purified by
flash column chromatography (3% CH OH/CH Cl ) affording the title compound (80
3 2 2
mg, 80% yield) as a solid. H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl ): δ 8.28 (s, 1H), 8.07 (d, 1H, J
= 7.6 Hz), 8.01 (d, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 7.62 (t, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 3.04 (s, 3H). ESI-MS:
215.1 [M+H] .
— 100 —
36. PREPARATION OF (E)-N ’-(1-(5-CHLOROHYDROXYPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)
(METHYLSULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
1-(5-Chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethanone (55mg, 0.322 mmol) and 3-
(methylsulfonyl) benzohydrazide (69.1 mg, 0.322 mmol) were dissolved in methanol
(5 mL) in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst, and the reaction mixture was
heated via microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. The reaction was monitored
by TLC. Upon completion of the reaction and following cooling, the solvent was
removed by vacuum, and the resulting crude material was purified by flash column
chromatography (3% CH OH/CH Cl ) affording the title compound (75 mg, 63.4%
3 2 2
yield) as a solid. H NMR (400 MHz, CD OD): δ 8.49 (s, 1H), 8.26 (d, 1H, J = 8.4
Hz), 8.18 (d, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 7.80 (t, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 7.60 (d, 1H, J = 2.4 Hz), 7.27
(m, 1H), 6.93 (d, 1H, J = 8.8 Hz), 3.19 (s, 3H), 2.49 (s, 3H). ESI-MS: 367.8 [M+H] .
37. PREPARATION OF 3-((4-METHYLPIPERIDINYL)SULFONYL)BENZOIC ACID.
4-methylpiperidine (180 mg, 1.813 mmol) was added to the 3-
(chlorosulfonyl)benzoic acid (200 mg, 0.906 mmol) in presence of
Potassiumcarbonate (251 mg, 1.813 mmol) in THF (Volume: 5 ml) at room
temperature and the reaction mixture was stirred for 12 h at room termperature.
Reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, the solvent was
removed by vacuum and then compound was purified by column chromatography
(3% CH OH/CH Cl ) afforded the title compound as a solid. 1H NMR (CD OD, 400
3 2 2 3
MHz): δ 8.32 (m, 1H), 8.27 (m, 1H), 7.96 (m, 1H), 7.72 (t, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 3.72 (m,
2H), 2.27 (m, 2H), 1.68 (m, 2H), 1.29 (m, 1H), 1.21 (m, 2H), 0.88 (d, 3H, J = 6.4 Hz).
ESI-MS: 284.1 [M+H]+
— 101 —
38. PREPARATION OF METHYL 3-((4-METHYLPIPERIDINYL)SULFONYL)BENZOATE.
3-((4-methylpiperidinyl)sulfonyl)benzoic acid (120 mg, 0.424 mmol)
was refluxed in the presence of con. Sulfuric acid (2.74 mg, 0.021 mmol) in
methanol at 70 °C for overnight. Reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion
of the reaction, the solvent was removed by vacuum and then compound was
purified by flash chromatography afforded the methyl 3-((4-methylpiperidin
yl)sulfonyl)benzoate (100 mg, 0.319 mmol, 75 % yield). 1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz):
δ 8.39 (m, 1H), 8.25 (m, 1H), 7.94 (m, 1H), 7.62 (t, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 3.95 (s, 3H),
3.77 (m, 2H), 2.25 (m, 2H), 1.67 (m, 2H), 1.29 (m, 3H), 0.90 (d, 3H, J = 4.8 Hz). ESI-
MS: 298.1[M+H]+
39. PREPARATION OF 2-(MORPHOLINOSULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
Hydrazine (22.46 mg, 0.701 mmol) was added to the methyl 2-
(morpholinosulfonyl)benzoate (100 mg, 0.350 mmol) in methanol and refluxed for 12
h at 70 °C. Following cooling, Reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of
the reaction, the solvent was removed by vacuum and then compound was purified
by flash chromatography afforded the title compound 2-
(morpholinosulfonyl)benzohydrazide (40 mg, 0.129 mmol, 36.8 % yield) as a solid.
1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz): δ 7.86 (m, 1H), 7.66-7.56 (m, 2H), 7.52 (dd, 1H, J = 1.2
& 7.6 Hz), 7.40 (m, 1H), 4.09 (m, 2H), 3.70 (m, 4H), 3.15 (m, 4H). ESI-MS:
286.1[M+H]+
— 102 —
40. PREPARATION OF 3-((4-METHYLPIPERIDINYL)SULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
Methyl 3-((4-methylpiperidinyl)sulfonyl)benzoate (100 mg, 0.336
mmol) was added to the hydrazine (21.55 mg, 0.673 mmol) in methanol and refluxed
for 8 h at 65 C. Following cooling, reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion
of the reaction, the solvent was removed by vacuum and then compound was
purified by column chromatography to yield3-((4-methylpiperidin
yl)sulfonyl)benzohydrazide (70 mg, 0.217 mmol, 64.4 % yield). 1H NMR (CD3OD,
400 MHz): δ 8.16 (m, 1H), 8.05 (m, 1H), 7.91 (m, 1H), 7.70 (t, 1H, J = 7.6Hz), 3.74
(m, 2H), 2.28 (m, 2H), 1.69 (m, 2H), 1.32-1.16 (m, 3H), 0.90 (d, 3H, J = 6.0 Hz). ESI-
MS: 298.1[M+H]+
41. PREPARATION OF (E)-N'-(1-(5-CHLOROHYDROXYPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)((4-
METHYLPIPERIDINYL)SULFONYL)BENZOHYDRA ZIDE.
3-((4-methylpiperidinyl)sulfonyl)benzohydrazide (70 mg, 0.235
mmol) and 1-(5-chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethanone (40.2 mg, 0.235 mmol) was
dissolved in Methanol (Volume: 4 ml) in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst and
then the reaction mixture was heated via microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min.
Reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, following cooling,
the solvent was removed by vacuum and the resulting crude material was purified by
flash column chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) afforded the title compound (E)-
3 2 2
N'-(1-(5-chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethylidene)((4-methylpiperidin
yl)sulfonyl)benzohydrazide (15 mg, 0.032 mmol, 13.60 % yield) as a solid. 1H NMR
(CDCl3, 400 MHz): δ 8.11 (m, 2H), 7.81 (m, 1H), 7.59 (m, 1H), 7.39 (m, 1H), 7.19
(m, 1H), 6.89 (m, 1H), 3.69 (m, 2H), 2.41 (m, 2H), 2.24 (m, 2H), 1.63 (m, 2H), 1.24
(m, 4H), 0.87 (d, 3H, J = 4.4 Hz). Mass [M+H]+ :450.2
— 103 —
42. PREPARATION OF (E)-N'-(1-(5-CHLOROFLUOROPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)
(MORPHOLINOSULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
1-(5-chlorofluorophenyl)ethanone (20 mg, 0.116 mmol) and 3-
(morpholinosulfonyl)benzohydrazide (33.1 mg, 0.116 mmol) was dissolved in
Methanol (Volume: 4 ml) in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst and then the
reaction mixture was heated via microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. Reaction
was monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, following cooling, the
solvent was removed by vacuum and the resulting crude material was purified by
flash column chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) afforded the title compound (E)-
3 2 2
N'-(1-(5-chlorofluorophenyl)ethylidene)(morpholinosulfonyl)benzohydrazide (10
mg, 0.022 mmol, 19.22 % yield) as a solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz): δ 8.26 (m,
1H), 8.09 (m, 1H), 7.80 (d, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 7.58 (t, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 7.37 (m, 1H),
7.21 (m, 1H), 6.95 (m, 1H), 3.61 (m, 4H), 2.90 (m, 4H), 2.29 (s, 3H). Mass [M+H]+
:440.1
43. PREPARATION OF METHYL 3-(PYRROLIDINYLSULFONYL)BENZOATE.
3-(pyrrolidinylsulfonyl)benzoic acid (200 mg, 0.783 mmol) was
refluxed in the presence of con. Sulfuric acid (5.06 mg, 0.039 mmol) in methanol at
70 °C for overnight. Reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the
reaction, solvent was removed by vacuum and then compound was purified by flash
chromatography afforded the methyl 3-(pyrrolidinylsulfonyl)benzoate (150 mg,
0.535 mmol, 68.3 % yield). 1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz): δ 8.47 (m, 1H), 8.25 (d, 1H,
J = 7.6 Hz), 8.02 (dt, 1H, J = 1.2 & 8.0 Hz), 7.63 (t, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 3.96 (s,3H), 3.27
(m, 4H), 1.77 (m, 4H). Mass [M+H]+ :270.1
— 104 —
44. PREPARATION OF METHYL 3-(N-METHYLSULFAMOYL)BENZOATE.
3-(N-methylsulfamoyl)benzoic acid (200 mg, 0.929 mmol) was refluxed
in the presence of concentrated sulfuric acid (6.01 mg, 0.046 mmol) in methanol at
70 °C for overnight. Reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the
reaction, the solvent was removed by vacuum and then compound was purified by
flash chromatography afforded the methyl 3-(N-methylsulfamoyl)benzoate (120 mg,
0.497 mmol, 53.5 % yield). 1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz): δ 8.51 (m, 1H), 8.25 (m,
1H), 8.06 (dt, 1H, J = 1.2 & 8.0 Hz), 7.63 (t, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 3.96 (s, 3H), 2.69 (s,
3H). Mass [M+H]+ :230.1
45. PREPARATION OF 3-(PYRROLIDINYLSULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
Methyl 3-(pyrrolidinylsulfonyl)benzoate (150 mg, 0.557 mmol) was
added to the hydrazine (35.7 mg, 1.114 mmol) in methanol and refluxed for 12 h at
65 °C. Following cooling, reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the
reaction, the solvent was removed by vacuum and then compound was purified by
column chromatography to yield 3-(pyrrolidinylsulfonyl)benzohydrazide (110 mg,
0.396 mmol, 71.1 % yield). 1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz): δ 8.18 (m, 1H), 8.03 (d, 1H,
J = 7.6 Hz), 7.97 (d, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 7.78 (bs, 1H), 7.63 (t, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 4.17 (bs,
2H), 3.25 (m, 4H), 1.77 (m, 4H). Mass [M+H]+: 270.1
46. PREPARATION OF 3-(HYDRAZINECARBONYL)-N-METHYLBENZENESULFONAMIDE.
— 105 —
Hydrazine (43.3 mg, 1.352 mmol) was added to the methyl 3-(N-
methylsulfamoyl)benzoate (155 mg, 0.676 mmol) in methanol and refluxed for 12 h
at 65 oC. Following cooling, reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the
reaction, the solvent was removed by vacuum and then compound was purified by
column chromatography to yield 3-(hydrazinecarbonyl)-N-
methylbenzenesulfonamide (120 mg, 0.502 mmol, 74.3 % yield). 1H NMR (CDCl3,
400 MHz): δ 8.25 (m, 1H), 8.01 (m, 2H), 7.64 (m, 2H), 4.63 (m, 1H), 4.17 (m, 2H),
2.69 (d, 3H, J = 5.2 Hz). ESI-MS: 230.0 [M+H]+
47. PREPARATION OF (E)-N'-(1-(5-CHLOROHYDROXYPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)
(MORPHOLINOSULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
2-(morpholinosulfonyl)benzohydrazide (30 mg, 0.105 mmol) and 1-(5-
chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethanone (17.94 mg, 0.105 mmol) was dissolved in
Methanol (Volume: 4 ml) in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst and then the
reaction mixture was heated via microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. Reaction
was monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, following cooling, the
solvent was removed by vacuum and the resulting crude material was purified by
flash column chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) afforded the title compound (E)-
3 2 2
N'-(1-(5-chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethylidene)(morpholinosulfonyl)benzohydrazide
(10 mg, 0.022 mmol, 21.28 % yield) as a solid. 1H NMR (CD OD, 400 MHz): δ 7.95
(d, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 7.95-7.70 (m, 2H), 7.66 (d, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 7.56 (d, 1H, J = 2.8
Hz), 7.25 (dd, 1H, J = 2.8 & 8.8 Hz), 6.91 (d, 1H, J = 8.4 Hz), 3.66 (m, 4H), 3.2(m,
4H), 2.36 (s, 3H). Mass [M+H]+ :438.1
— 106 —
48. PREPARATION OF (E)(2-(1-(5-CHLORO
HYDROXYPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)HYDRAZINECARBONYL)-N-
METHYLBENZENESULFONAMDE.
3-(hydrazinecarbonyl)-N-methylbenzenesulfonamide (120 mg, 0.523
mmol) and 1-(5-chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethanone (89 mg, 0.523 mmol) was
dissolved in Methanol (Volume: 4 ml) in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst and
then the reaction mixture was heated via microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min.
Reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, following cooling,
the solvent was removed by vacuum and the resulting crude material was purified by
flash column chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) afforded the title compound (E)-
3 2 2
3-(2-(1-(5-chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethylidene)hydrazinecarbonyl)-N-
methylbenzenesulfonamide (75 mg, 0.192 mmol, 36.8 % yield) as a solid. 1H NMR
(CDCl3, 400 MHz): δ 8.21 (m, 1H), 8.06 (m, 1H), 7.95 (d, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 7.59 (t,
1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 7.39 (d, 1H, J = 2.4 Hz), 7.18 (m, 1H), 6.90 (d, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 2.56
(s, 3H), 2.36 (s, 3H). Mass [M+H]+ :382.1
49. PREPARATION OF (E)-N'-(1-(5-CHLOROHYDROXYPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)
(PYRROLIDINYLSULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
3-(pyrrolidinylsulfonyl)benzohydrazide (105 mg, 0.390 mmol) and 1-
(5-chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethanone (66.5 mg, 0.390 mmol) was dissolved in
Methanol (Volume: 4 ml) in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst and then the
reaction mixture was heated via microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. Reaction
was monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, following cooling, the
solvent was removed by vacuum and the resulting crude material was purified by
flash column chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) afforded the title compound (E)-
3 2 2
— 107 —
N'-(1-(5-chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethylidene)(pyrrolidinylsulfonyl)benzohydrazide
(70 mg, 0.163 mmol, 41.7 % yield) as a solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz): δ 8.18
(m, 1H), 8.13 (m, 1H), 7.95 (d, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 7.65 (t, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 7.41 (m, 1H),
7.21 (m, 1H), 6.93 (d, 1H, J = 8.8 Hz), 3.23 (m, 4H), 2.39 (s, 3H), 1.75 (m, 4H). Mass
[M+H]+ :422.1
50. PREPARATION OF METHYL 3-(1,1-DIOXIDOTHIOMORPHOLINO)BENZOATE.
3-(1,1-dioxidothiomorpholino)benzoic acid (100 mg, 0.392 mmol) was
refluxed in the presence of con. Sulfuric acid (2.53 mg, 0.020 mmol) in methanol(5
mL) at 70 °C for overnight. Reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the
reaction, the solvent was removed by vacuum and then compound was purified by
flash chromatography afforded the methyl 3-(1,1-dioxidothiomorpholino)benzoate
(99 mg, 0.353 mmol, 90 % yield). 1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz): δ 7.58 (m, 2H), 7.36
(t, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 7.09 (m, 1H), 3.91 (s, 3H), 3.89 (m, 4H), 3.11 (m, 4H). Mass
[M+H]+: 270.1
51. PREPARATION OF 3-(1,1-DIOXIDOTHIOMORPHOLINO)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
Methyl 3-(1,1-dioxidothiomorpholino)benzoate (95 mg, 0.353 mmol)
was addedto the hydrazine (22.61 mg, 0.705 mmol) in methanol and refluxed for 12
h at 65 °C. Following cooling, Reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of
the reaction, the solvent was removed by vacuum and then compound was purified
by column chromatography (2% CH3OH/CH2Cl2) afforded the title compound 3-
(1,1-dioxidothiomorpholino)benzohydrazide (32 mg, 0.109 mmol, 31.0 % yield) as a
solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz): δ 7.34 (m, 1H), 7.29 (t, 1H, J = 8.4 Hz), 7.18 (d,
— 108 —
1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 6.70 (dd,1H, J = 4.8 & 8.0 Hz), 3.85 (m, 4H), 3.05 (m, 4H). Mass
[M+H]+ :270.1
52. PREPARATION OF (E)-N'-(1-(5-CHLOROHYDROXYPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)
(1,1-DIOXIDOTHIOMORPHOLINO)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
3-(1,1-dioxidothiomorpholino)benzohydrazide (30 mg, 0.111 mmol) and
1-(5-chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethanone (19.00 mg, 0.111 mmol) was dissolved in
methanol (Volume: 4 ml) in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst and then the
reaction mixture was heated via microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. Reaction
was monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, following cooling, the
solvent was removed by vacuum and the resulting crude material was purified by
flash column chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) afforded the title compound (E)-
3 2 2
N'-(1-(5-chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethylidene)(1,1-
dioxidothiomorpholino)benzohydrazide (15 mg, 0.035 mmol, 31.3 % yield) as a solid.
1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 400 MHz): δ 7.65 (d, 1H, J = 2.0 Hz), 7.47 (m, 1H), 7.41 (t, 1H,
J = 7.6 Hz), 7.36-7.27 (m, 3H), 6.94 (d, 1H, J = 8.8 Hz), 3.87 (m, 4H), 3.17 (m, 4H),
2.48 (s, 3H). Mass [M+H]+ :422.2
53. PREPARATION OF (E)-N'-(1-(5-CHLORONITROPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)
(MORPHOLINOSULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
1-(5-chloronitrophenyl)ethanone (30 mg, 0.150 mmol) and 3-
(morpholinosulfonyl)benzohydrazide (42.9 mg, 0.150 mmol) was dissolved in
Methanol (Volume: 4 ml) in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst and then the
reaction mixture was heated via microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. Reaction
was monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, following cooling, the
— 109 —
solvent was removed by vacuum and the resulting crude material was purified by
flash column chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ), afforded the product (E)-N'-(1-
3 2 2
(5-chloronitrophenyl)ethylidene)(morpholinosulfonyl)benzohydrazide (15 mg,
0.030 mmol, 20.09 % yield) as a solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz): δ 8.20 (m, 1H),
8.07 (m, 1H), 7.88 (m, 1H), 7.66 (m,1H), 7.51 (m, 2H), 7.39 (m, 1H), 3.69 (m, 4H),
2.99 (m, 4H), 2.29 (s, 3H). Mass [M+H]+ :468.0
54. PREPARATION OF METHYL 3-SULFAMOYLBENZOATE.
3-sulfamoylbenzoic acid (150mg, 0.746 mmol) was refluxed in the
presence of concentrated Sulfuric acid (4.82 mg, 0.037 mmol) in methanol (5 mL) at
70 °C for overnight. Reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the
reaction, Solvent was removed by vacuum and then compound was purified by flash
chromatography afforded the methyl 3-sulfamoylbenzoate (115 mg, 0.524 mmol,
70.2 % yield) as a solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz): δ 8.53 (m, 1H), 8.18 (d, 1H, J =
8.0 Hz), 8.08 (d, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 7.57 (t,1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 3.92 (s, 3H). Mass [M+H]+
:216.0
55. PREPARATION OF METHYL 4-(MORPHOLINOSULFONYL)BENZOATE.
4-(morpholinosulfonyl)benzoic acid (150 mg, 0.553 mmol) was refluxed
in the presence of con. Sulfuric acid (3.57 mg, 0.028 mmol) in methanol at 70 °C for
overnight. Reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, solvent
was removed by vacuum and then compound was purified by flash chromatography
afforded the methyl 4-(morpholinosulfonyl)benzoate (135 mg, 0.464 mmol, 84 %
yield). 1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz): δ 8.21 (m, 2H), 7.82 (m, 2H), 3.97 (s, 3H), 3.4
(m, 4H), 3.02 (m, 4H). Mass [M+H]+ :286.0
— 110 —
56. PREPARATION OF 3-(HYDRAZINECARBONYL)BENZENESULFONAMIDE.
Methyl 3-sulfamoylbenzoate (110 mg, 0.511 mmol) was added to the
hydrazine (32.8 mg, 1.022 mmol) in methanol and refluxed for 8 h at 65 °C.
Following cooling, reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction,
the solvent was removed by vacuum and then compound was purified by flash
chromatography (5% methanol/DCM) to yield the 3-
(hydrazinecarbonyl)benzenesulfonamide (57 mg, 0.260 mmol, 50.8 % yield) as a
white solid. 1H NMR (CD3OD, 400 MHz): δ 8.32 (m, 1H), 8.04 (d, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz),
7.97 (d, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 7.63 (t, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz). Mass [M+H]+ :216.0
57. PREPARATION OF 4-(MORPHOLINOSULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
Methyl 4-(morpholinosulfonyl)benzoate (135 mg, 0.473 mmol) was
added to the hydrazine (30.3 mg, 0.946 mmol) in methanol and refluxed for 8 h at 65
°C. Following cooling, reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the
reaction, the solvent was removed by vacuum and then compound was purified by
flash chromatography (3% methanol/DCM) to yield the 4-
(morpholinosulfonyl)benzohydrazide (102 mg, 0.350 mmol, 74.0 % yield) as a white
solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz): δ 7.94 (m, 2H), 7.79 (m, 2H), 3.72 (m, 4H), 2.99
(m, 4H). Mass [M+H]+ :286.0
58. PREPARATION OF (E)(2-(1-(5-CHLORO
HYDROXYPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)HYDRAZINECARBONYL)BENZENESULFONAMIDE.
— 111 —
3-(hydrazinecarbonyl)benzenesulfonamide (50 mg, 0.232 mmol) and 1-
(5-chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethanone (39.6 mg, 0.232 mmol) was dissolved in
methanol (Volume: 4 ml) in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst and then the
reaction mixture was heated via microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. Reaction
was monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, following cooling, the
solvent was removed by vacuum and the resulting crude material was purified by
flash column chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) afforded the product (E)(2-(1-
3 2 2
(5-chlorohydroxyphenyl) ethylidene)hydrazinecarbonyl)benzenesulfonamide (36
mg, 0.094 mmol, 40.4 % yield) as a solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 400 MHz): δ 8.34 (s,
1H), 8.15 (d, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 8.02 (d, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 7.73 (t, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 7.64
(m, 1H), 7.51 (bs, 2H), 7.32 (dd, 1H, J = 2.4 & 8.4 Hz), 6.92 (d, 1H, J = 8.4 Hz), 2.49
(s, 3H). Mass [M+H]+ :368.0
59. PREPARATION OF (E)-N'-(1-(5-CHLOROHYDROXYPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)
(MORPHOLINOSULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
4-(morpholinosulfonyl)benzohydrazide (100 mg, 0.350 mmol) and 1-(5-
chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethanone (59.8 mg, 0.350 mmol) was dissolved in methanol
(Volume: 4 ml) in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst and then the reaction
mixture was heated via microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. Reaction was
monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, following cooling, the solvent
was removed by vacuum and the resulting crude material was purified by flash
column chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) afforded the product (E)-N'-(1-(5-
3 2 2
chlorohydroxyphenyl) ethylidene)(morpholinosulfonyl)benzohydrazide (80 mg,
0.177 mmol, 50.6 % yield) as a solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 400 MHz): δ 8.16 (m,
— 112 —
2H), 7.89 (m, 2H), 7.67 (d, 1H, J = 2.4 Hz), 7.35 (dd, 1H, J = 2.4 & 8.8 Hz), 6.95 (d,
1H, J = 8.4 Hz), 3.64 (m, 4H), 2.92 (m, 4H), 2.49 (s, 3H). Mass [M+H]+ :438.0
60. PREPARATION OF 3-((4-METHYLPIPERAZINYL)SULFONYL)BENZOIC ACID.
3-(chlorosulfonyl)benzoic acid (200 mg, 0.906 mmol) was added to the
1-methylpiperazine (100 mg, 0.997 mmol) in presence of potassium carbonate (251
mg, 1.813 mmol) in THF (Volume: 5 ml) at room temperature and the reaction
mixture was stirred for 12 h at room termperature. Reaction was monitored by TLC.
After completion of the reaction, the solvent was removed by vacuum and then
compound was purified by column chromatography (3% CH OH/CH Cl ) afforded
3 2 2
the product 3-((4-methylpiperazinyl)sulfonyl)benzoic acid (100 mg, 0.320 mmol,
.3 % yield) as a solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz): δ 7.77 (m, 2H), 7.63-7.55 (m,
2H), 3.04 (m, 4H), 2.46 (m 4H), 2.31 (s, 3H). Mass [M+H]+ :285.1
61. PREPARATION OF METHYL 3-((4-METHYLPIPERAZINYL)SULFONYL)BENZOATE.
3-((4-methylpiperazinyl)sulfonyl)benzoic acid (250 mg, 0.879 mmol)
was refluxed in the presence of concentrated sulfuric acid (5.68 mg, 0.044 mmol) in
methanol at 70 °C for overnight. Reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion
of the reaction, solvent was removed by vacuum and the crude material was used
for further reaction without purification.
62. PREPARATION OF 3-((4-METHYLPIPERAZINYL)SULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
— 113 —
Methyl 3-((4-methylpiperazinyl)sulfonyl)benzoate (200 mg, 0.670
mmol) was added to the hydrazine (43.0 mg, 1.341 mmol) in methanol and refluxed
for 8 h at 65 °C. Following cooling, reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion
of the reaction, the solvent was removed by vacuum and then compound was
purified by flash chromatography (3% methanol/DCM) to yield the 3-((4-
methylpiperazinyl)sulfonyl)benzohydrazide (125 mg, 0.406 mmol, 60.6 % yield) as
a white solid. 1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 400 MHz): δ 10.08 (s, 1H), 8.12 (m, 2H), 7.84 (d,
1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 7.72 (t, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 4.57 (m, 1H), 2.88 (m, 4H), 2.32 (m, 4H),
2.10 (s, 3H). Mass [M+H]+ :298.9
63. PREPARATION OF (E)-N'-(1-(5-CHLOROHYDROXYPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)((4-
METHYLPIPERAZINYL)SULFONYL) BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
3-((4-methylpiperazinyl)sulfonyl)benzohydrazide (85 mg, 0.285
mmol) and 1-(5-chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethanone (48.6 mg, 0.285 mmol) was
dissolved in methanol (Volume: 4 ml) in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst and
then the reaction mixture was heated via microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min.
Reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, following cooling,
the solvent was removed by vacuum and the resulting crude material was purified by
flash column chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) afforded the product (E)-N'-(1-(5-
3 2 2
chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethylidene)((4-methylpiperazin
yl)sulfonyl)benzohydrazide (70 mg, 0.152 mmol, 53.4 % yield) as a solid. 1H NMR
(CD3OD, 400 MHz): δ 8.29 (s, 1H), 8.21 (d, 1H, J = 7.2 Hz), 7.99 (d, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz),
7.78 (t, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 7.59 (d, 1H, J = 2.4 Hz), 7.27 (dd, 1H, J = 2.4 & 9.2 Hz),
6.92 (d, 1H, J = 8.8 Hz), 3.09 (m, 4H), 2.54 (m, 4H), 2.48 (s, 3H), 2.28 (s, 3H). Mass
[M+H]+ :450.9
— 114 —
64. PREPARATION OF 3-(PIPERIDINYLSULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
Methyl 3-(piperidinylsulfonyl)benzoate (150 mg, 0.529 mmol) was
added to the hydrazine (50.9 mg, 1.588 mmol) in methanol and refluxed for 8 h at 65
°C. Following cooling, reaction was monitored by TLC. After completion of the
reaction, solvent was removed by vacuum and then compound was purified by flash
chromatography (3% methanol/DCM) to yield the 3-(piperidin
ylsulfonyl)benzohydrazide (70 mg, 0.245 mmol, 46.2 % yield) as a white solid. 1H
NMR (CD3OD, 400 MHz): δ 8.17 (t, 1H, J = 1.2 Hz), 8.05 (dt, 1H, J = 1.2 & 8.0 Hz),
7.90 (dt, 1H, J = 1.2 & 8.0 Hz), 7.69 (t, 1H, J = 7.6 Hz), 2.99 (m, 4H), 1.62 (m, 4H),
1.43 (m, 2H). Mass [M+H]+ :284.1
65. PREPARATION OF (E)-N'-(1-(5-CHLOROHYDROXYPHENYL)ETHYLIDENE)
(PIPERIDINYLSULFONYL)BENZOHYDRAZIDE.
3-(piperidinylsulfonyl)benzohydrazide (65 mg, 0.229 mmol) and 1-
(5-chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethanone (39.1 mg, 0.229 mmol) was dissolved in
methanol (Volume: 4 ml) in the presence of acetic acid as a catalyst and then the
reaction mixture was heated via microwave irradiation to 120 °C for 30 min. Reaction
was monitored by TLC. After completion of the reaction, following cooling, the
solvent was removed by vacuum and the resulting crude material was purified by
flash column chromatography (2% CH OH/CH Cl ) afforded the product (E)-N'-(1-(5-
3 2 2
chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethylidene)(piperidinylsulfonyl)benzohydrazide (55 mg,
0.124 mmol, 53.9 % yield) as a solid. 1H NMR (CDCl3, 400 MHz): δ 8.09 (m, 2H),
7.85 (d, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 7.62 (t, 1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 7.41 (d, 1H, J = 2.4 Hz), 7.22 (d,
1H, J = 8.0 Hz), 6.93 (d, 1H, J = 8.8 Hz), 2.97 (m, 4H), 2.41 (s, 3H), 1.61 (m, 4H),
1.40 (m, 2H). Mass [M+H]+ :436.9
— 115 —
66. GENERAL BIOCHEMICAL AND CELL MATERIALS AND METHODS
LSD1 activity was determined using a LSD1 Inhibitor Screening Assay
Kit (Cayman Chemical Item Number 700120) purchased from Cayman Chemical
Company (Ann Arbor, Michigan). Recombinant (expressed in baculovirus infected
BTI insect cells) monoamine oxidase A and monoamine oxidase B (Catalog No.
M7316 and M7441, respectively) were purchased from Sigma-Aldrich Co. LLC. (St.
Louis, Missouri). MAO-Glo™ Assay Kit was purchased from Promega Corporation
(Madison, Wisconsin). ATPlite™ Luminescence Assay System (e.g. Catalog No.
V1401) was purchased from PerkinElmer Inc. (Waltham, Massachussetts).
67. CELL CULTURE
Cancer cell lines were obtained from ATCC. Cells were cultured
according to the procedures provided. Cell-lines used included those shown in
Table 4 below. In addition to the supplements indicated in Table 4, media were also
supplemented with 1% penicillin/streptomycin (100 IU/mL penicillin and 100 g/mL
streptomycin). Cells were cultured at 37 C and 5% CO . ATCC is the American
Type Culture Collection (Manassas, Virginia).
TABLE 4.
Cell-line ATCC® Organ/tissue/pathology* Culture Media
Number
AN3 CA HTB-111™ Uterine / endometrium / Eagle’s Minimum Essential
adenocarcinoma Medium supplemented with 10%
FCS**
BT-20 HTB-19™ Breast / carcinoma Eagle’s Minimum Essential
Medium supplemented with 10%
BT-549 HTB-122™ Breast / ductal carcinoma RPMI-1640 Medium
supplemented with 0.023 IU/ml
insulin and 10% FCS
HCT 116 CCL-247™ Colon / colorectal carcinoma McCoy’s 5a Medium Modified
supplemented with 10% FCS
HER218*** Not applicable Breast / adenocarcinoma RPMI-1640 Medium
supplemented and 10% FCS
MCF7 HTB-22™ Breast / adenocarcinoma Eagle’s Minimum Essential
Medium supplemented with 0.01
mg/ml bovine insulin and 10%
FCS.
MDA-MB-231 HTB-26™ Breast / adenocarcinoma Leibovitz’s L-15 Medium
supplemented with 10% FCS
— 116 —
Cell-line ATCC® Organ/tissue/pathology* Culture Media
Number
MDA-MB-435S HTB-129™ Pleural effusion; likely Leibovitz’s L-15 Medium
melanoma supplemented with 0.01mg/ml
bovine insulin, •0.01mg/ml
glutathione, and 10% FCS
MDA-MB-468 HTB-132™ Breast / adenocarcinoma Leibovitz’s L-15 Medium
supplemented with 10% FCS
PANC-1 CRL-1469™ Pancreas / duct / epithelioid Dulbecco’s Modified Eagle’s
carcinoma Medium supplemented with 10%
PC-3 CRL-1435™ Prostate adenocarcinoma F-12K Medium supplemented
with 10% FCS
SK-N-MC HTB-10™ Brain / neuroepithelioma Eagle’s Minimum Essential
Medium supplemented with 10%
T-47D HTB-133™ Breast / ductal carcinoma RPMI-1640 Medium
supplemented with 0.2 units/ml
bovine insulin and 10% FCS
U-87 MG HTB-14™ Brain / glioblastoma, Eagle’s Minimum Essential
astrocytoma Medium supplemented with 10%
* All organ/tissue sources were of human origin.
** FCS is Fetal Calf Serum
*** MCF7 cell-line derivative characterized by non-nuclear estrogen receptor and high levels
of HER2 (Massarweh S, et al. (2008) Cancer Research 68: 826-33).
68. LSD1 HISTONE DEMETHYLASE ASSAY
The primary assay for compound inhibitory activity was the LSD1
Inhibitor Screening Assay Kit (Cayman Chemical Company, Ann Arbor, Michigan;
Cayman Chemical Item Number 700120). Briefly, test compounds were diluted to
20X the desired test concentration in 100% DMSO and 2.5 μL of the diluted drug
sample was added to a black 384-well plate. The LSD1 enzyme stock was diluted
17-fold with assay buffer and 40 μM of the diluted LSD1 enzyme was added to the
appropriate wells. The reaction mixture comprised horseradish peroxidase, dimethyl
K4 peptide (corresponding to the first 21 amino acids of the N-terminal tail of histone
H3), and 10-acetyl-3,7-dihydroxyphenoxazine was then added to wells. Generation
of resorufin (generated by reacting with H O produced in the reaction) was
analyzed on an Envision microplate reader with an excitation wavelength of 530nm
and an emission wavelength of 595nm.
— 117 —
69. MONOAMINE OXIDASE (“M A O”) ASSAY
Inhibition of monoamine oxidase activity was carried used using the
MAO-Glo™ Assay Kit according to the manufacturer‘s suggested protocol. Briefly,
6.25 µL of test compound was added to each well of a 384-well plate. Enzyme
(either MAO A or B) was added (12.5µL in 2x buffer containing 1µg protein) and
allowed to incubate for 5 minutes. Finally, 6.25µL of 4x MAO substrate was added to
each well. Following a one hour incubation, 25µL of Luciferin detection reagent was
added to each well, and incubated for 20 minutes. Luminescence was then
measured on an Envision microplate reader. Representative data used to determine
IC for inhibition of each MAO isoform is provided in Figure 4, and representative
data for several compounds is summarized in Table 8 below.
70. CELL VIABILITY ASSAY
Cell viability was determined using ATPlite™ Luminescence Assay
System (PerkinElmer Inc., Waltham, Massachussetts) using the various cell-lines
described above and in Table 4. Briefly, cells were seeded in 96-well plates and
then treated with different concentrations of inhibitor (0.1% final DMSO
concentration). After 96-hours of incubation, ATPlite detection reagent was added
directly to the culture well. Luminescence was read 5 minutes later on an Envision
microplate reader. Representative IC data for inhibition of cell growth with various
cell-lines is provided below in Tables 6, 7, and 9.
71. REAL-TIME PCR
Briefly, T-47D cells were seeded in 96-well plates and treated with
concentrations of inhibitors as indicated. Cell lysates, Reverse transcription, and
single color syber green realtime PCR was performed using the Cells-to-Ct kit (Life
Technologies). Transcript levels of heme oxygenase (HMOX) were normalized to
hypoxanthine phosphoribosyltransferase (HPRT) and β-actin. The primers used in
real-time PCR are shown below in Table 5, and representative data for the effect of
disclosed compounds on HMOX expression are provided in Tables 6 and 7.
— 118 —
TABLE 5.
Primer Amplification Target Sequence
Designation
HMOX_F Heme oxygenase AACTTTCAGAAGGGCCAGGT
HMOX_R Heme oxygenase GTAGACAGGGGCGAAGACTG
HPRT_F Hypoxanthine TGCTGAGGATTTGGAAAGGGTG
phosphoribosyltransferase
HPRT_R Hypoxanthine CCTTGAGCACACAGAGGGCTAC
phosphoribosyltransferase
B-Actin_F β-actin CTGGAACGGTGAAGGTGACA
B-Actin_R β-actin AAGGGACTTCCTGTAACAACGCA
72. IC CALCULATION
IC values are determined using GraphPad Prism 5 software. The
data were entered as an X-Y plot into the software as percent inhibition for each
concentration of the drug. The concentration values of the drug were log
transformed and the nonlinear regression was carried out using the ―sigmoidal dose-
response (variable slope)‖ option within the GraphPad software to model the data
and calculate IC values. The IC values reported are the concentration of drug at
50 50
which 50% inhibition was reached.
73. COMPOUND ACTIVITY
The ability of representative disclosed compounds to modulate various
biochemical and cellular activities was determined using the assays described
above. The results are shown in the tables below. The IC (µM) for inhibition of
either LSD1 activity or cell growth using T-47D cells is shown in Tables 6 and 7. In
addition, the effect of representative compounds on heme oxygenase (HMOX)
expression is also shown in Tables 6 and 7. The IC for inhibition of monoamine
oxidases A (―MAO A‖) and B (―MAO B‖) by representative compounds compared to a
control compound, tranylcypromine, is shown in Table 8. The effect of Compound
No. 12 (in reference to the compound number used in Table 7, or (E)-N‘-(1-(5-
chlorohydroxyphenyl)ethylidene)(morpholinosulfonyl)benzohydrazide) on cell
growth for various cell-lines in shown in Table 9. If an IC or other assay result is
indicated as ―n.d.‖, it was not determined in the indicated assay.
— 119 —
Compound 12 was used to evaluate sensitivity in a panel of cancer cell
lines (Table 9). Cell line sensitivity to compound 12 in this viability assay varied by
one log, with IC values around 300nM to just under 3µM. For comparison among
the representative compounds, IC values were determined in T-47D cells (see
Tables 6 and 7). With few exceptions, it was observed that T-47D cells were
sensitive to test compounds that were active in the LSD1 biochemical assay, and
were less sensitive to the compounds which showed less activity in the LSD1 assay.
In order to add an additional level of analsysis of LSD1 inhibition in cell
culture by these compounds, expression array experiments were performed to
evaluate transcriptional changes induced by compound 12 (data not shown). These
data indicated that heme oxygenase 1 (HMOX1) was one of the most consistently
up-regulated genes across multiple cell lines following treatment with this compound.
As HMOX1 is known to be regulated by H3 methylation in the promoter (Krieg, A. J.,
et al. Mol Cell Biol 2010, 30 (1), 344-53), the effect of the test compounds on
HMOX1 expression in T-47D cells was determined (see Tables 6 and 7). The data
show that the representative compounds which are associated with upregulation of
HMOX1 expression are also associated inhibitory activity in the LSD1 assay and the
cell viability assay.
LSD1 has a high structural homology of to the monoamine oxidase
family of enzymes (17.6% for both monoamine oxidase A and B; MAO A and B,
respectively; e.g. see Gooden, D. M., et al. Bioorg Med Chem Lett 2008, 18 (10),
3047-51). Selective activity of the representative compounds for LSD1 compared to
either MAO A or MAO B, is a desirable property for therapeutic compounds targeting
LSD1. The specificity of compound 1 and compound 12 were tested in MAO
biochemical assays described herein (see Figure 3 for representative results which
are summarized in Table 8). In this assay, the known MAO inhibitor tranylcypromine
exhibited activity against both MAO A and B. In contrast, compound 1 exhibited
comparable activity to tranylcypromine against MAO B, but showed no activity
against MAO A. However, compound 12 does not exhibit activity against either
MAO enzyme (>300µM). Compounds 18 and 24 were also tested, and exhibited no
activity against MAO A or B, and the results are provided in Table 8. These results
demonstrate that the representative compounds have specificity for LSD1 with
— 120 —
significantly reduced effect on the MAO enzymes. It should be noted that both MAO
A and B differ from LSD1 in that the FAD is covalently bound to the enzyme through
a thioether linkage with Cys406 and Cys397, respectively (Kearney, E. B., et al.
European Journal of Biochemistry 1971, (24), 321-327; and Bach, A. W., et al. Proc
Natl Acad Sci USA 1988, (85), 4934-4938).
TABLE 6.
No. Structure LSD1 Cell HMOX
Activity, Growth, expression
IC (µM) IC (µM) (fold-
50 50
induction)
0.218 2.7 2.3
0.275 0.821 13
3 0.291 0.971 15.1
0.196 0.096 20.3
0.333 0.615 31.5
> 3 > 10 1.9
7 > 3 > 10 1.1
— 121 —
No. Structure LSD1 Cell HMOX
Activity, Growth, expression
IC (µM) IC (µM) (fold-
50 50
induction)
8 > 3 > 10 0.9
0.013 0.524 31.7
> 10 > 10 1.0
TABLE 7.
No. Structure LSD1 Cell HMOX
Activity, Growth, expression
IC (µM) IC (µM) (fold-
50 50
induction)
0.128 0.352 31.3
12 0.013 0.649 26.9
13 > 3 > 10 ND
> 3 > 10 1.1
— 122 —
No. Structure LSD1 Cell HMOX
Activity, Growth, expression
IC (µM) IC (µM) (fold-
50 50
induction)
> 3 > 10 ND
16 > 3 > 10 0.9
17 > 3 1.700 ND
18 0.013 0.565 56.4
> 3 1.375 ND
> 3 0.270 ND
21 > 3 0.616 ND
22 > 3 ND ND
0.519 ND ND
— 123 —
No. Structure LSD1 Cell HMOX
Activity, Growth, expression
IC (µM) IC (µM) (fold-
50 50
induction)
24 0.028 ND ND
0.049 ND 50.3
TABLE 8.
No. Structure MAO A, IC50 MAO B, IC50
(µM) (µM)
--- 2.1 3.6
1 88.5 1.3
12 > 300 > 300
18 > 300 > 300
24 >300 > 300
— 124 —
TABLE 9.
Cell-line Cell Growth, IC50 (µM)
AN3 Ca 0.356
BT-20 0.489
BT-549 1.010
HCT 116 0.614
HER218 0.612
HsT 1.700
HT29 0.429
MCF-7 0.637
MDA-MB-231 1.040
MDA-MB-235 0.728
MDA-MB-435 1.440
MDA-MB-468 2.730
MIA PaCa-2 0.468
PANC-1 1.104
PC-3 2.160
SK-N-MC 0.329
T-47D 0.649
U87 1.160
74. PROPHETIC IN VIVO ANTI-TUMOR EFFECTS: CELL-LINE XENOGRAFT MODEL
The following example of the in vivo effect of the disclosed compounds
are prophetic. Generally agents which modulate the regulation of chromatin,
including histone demethylase inhibitors, display efficacy in preclinical models of
cancer. In vivo effects of the compounds described in the preceding examples are
expected to be shown in various animal models of cancer known to the skilled
person, such as tumor xenograft models. These models are typically conducted in
rodent, most often in mouse, but may be conducted in other animal species as is
convenient to the study goals. Compounds, products, and compositions disclosed
herein are expected to show in vivo effects in various animal models of cancer
known to the skilled person, such as mouse tumor xenograft models.
In vivo effects of compounds can be assessed with in a mouse tumor
xenograft study, one possible study protocol is described herein. Briefly, cells (2 to 5
x 10 in 100 mL culture media) were implanted subcutaneously, e.g. by
— 125 —
subcutaneous injection, in the right hind flank of athymic nu/nu nude mice (5 to 6
weeks old, 18–22 g). For test compounds of the present invention, a typical cell-line
used for the tumor xenograft study would be AN3 CA or BT-20. Other suitable cell-
lines for these studies are BT-549, HCT 116, HER218, MCF7, MDA-MB-231, MDA-
MB-235, MDA-MB-435S, MDA-MB-468, PANC-1, PC-3, SK-N-MC, T-47D, and U-87
MG cells. The cells are cultured prior to harvesting for this protocol as described
herein.
Following implantation, the tumors are allowed to grow to about 100
mm , typically about 6-18 days post-implantation, before the animals are
randomized into treatment groups (e.g. vehicle, positive control and various dose
levels of the test compound); the number of animals per group is typically 8-12. Day
1 of study corresponds to the day that the animals receive their first dose. The
efficacy of a test compound can be determined in studies of various length
dependent upon the goals of the study. Typical study periods are for 14, 21 and 28-
days. The dosing frequency (e.g. whether animals are dosed with test compound
daily, every other day, every third day or other frequencies) is determined for each
study depending upon the toxicity and potency of the test compound. A typical study
design would involve dosing daily (M-F) with the test compound with recovery on the
weekend. Throughout the study, tumor volumes and body weights are measured
twice a week. At the end of the study the animals are euthanized and the tumors
harvested and frozen for further analysis. Alternatively, tumors may be processed
immediately for analysis, e.g. fixed in buffered-formalin, paraffin embedded, and
sectioned for hematoxylin/eosin staining and further immunohistochemical analysis
for desired oncology markers.
For example, compounds described herein, or a pharmaceutically
acceptable salt, solvate, polymorph, hydrate and the stereochemically isomeric form
thereof, are expected to show such in vivo effects.
75. PROPHETIC IN VIVO ANTI-TUMOR EFFECTS: TUMOR GRAFT MODEL
Alternatively, it can be desirable to assess the in vivo efficacy of the
disclosed compounds in a tumor explant or tumor graft animal models (e.g. see
Rubio-Viqueira B., et al. Clin Cancer Res. (2006) 12:4652-4661; Fiebig, H.H., Maier,
— 126 —
A. and Burger, A.M. Eur. J. Canc. (2004) 40:802-820; and DeRose, Y.S., et al.
―Patient−derived tumor grafts authentically reflect tumor pathology, growth,
metastasis and disease outcomes.‖ (2011) Nat. Med., in press). These models can
provide higher quality information on in vivo effects of therapeutic compounds. It is
believed tumor graft models are more authentic in vivo models of many types of
cancer, e.g. human breast cancer, with which to examine the biology of tumors and
how they metastasize. Engraftment of actual patient tumor tissues into
immunodeficient mice (termed ‗tumor grafts‘) provides improvement over
implantation of cell lines, in terms of phenocopying human tumors and predicting
drug responses in patients (Clarke, R. Breast Cancer Res (2009) 11 Suppl 3, S22;
Press, J.Z., et al. Gynecol Oncol (2008) 110:56-264; Kim, M.P., et al. Nat Protoc
(2009) 4:670-1680; Daniel, V.C., et al. Cancer Res (2009) 69:3364-3373; and Ding,
L., et al. Nature (2010) 464:999-1005).
Briefly, tissue samples will be collected from informed, consented
patients at Huntsman Cancer Hospital/University of Utah under an approved IRB
protocol. Samples will be collected and de-identified by the Huntsman Cancer
Institute Tissue Resource and Application Core facility before being obtained for
implantation. It is anticipated that all primary tumors will be from individuals that had
not received chemotherapy prior to tissue collection, and and all metastatic effusions
will be from individuals that had been treated with chemotherapy, hormone therapy,
and/or radiation therapy. The University of Utah Institutional Animal Care and Use
Committee will review and approve all mouse experiments. It is anticipated that a
minimum of three mice per experimental group will be used, and only female mice
will be used for studies involving breast cancer tumors. A single fragment of fresh or
frozen tumor (~8 mm3), or about 10 cells in matrigel, is implanted into cleared
inguinal mammary fat pads of 3–4 week old female NOD/SCID mice. At the same,
interscapular estrogen pellets are subcutaneously implanted in mice with ER+
tumors. Tumor growth is measured weekly using calipers. When tumors reach about
150-2,000 mm , the mice are euthanized, and tissue fragments are re-transplanted
into another cohort of mice, frozen for later use, and/or analyzed for histology, gene
expression, and DNA copy number. Tumor volumes are calculated using the formula
0.5 × length × (width) . For experiments to determine estrogen dependence, ER
tumors are implanted into mice as described above, in the presence or absence of
— 127 —
intrascapular estrogen pellets and with or without a concurrent surgical procedure to
remove the ovaries, which is performed according to standard methods.
Freshly harvested tumor tissues from patients or mice are cut into ~8
mm3 pieces and stored in liquid nitrogen, in a solution of 95% FBS and 5% DMSO
for later implantation. Alternatively, the tissue is digested with collagenase solution
(1 mg/ml collagenase [Type IV, Sigma] in RPMI 1640 supplemented with 2.5% FBS,
mM HEPES, 10 µg/mL penicillin–streptomycin) at 37°C for 40–60 min, while
shaking at 250 rpm. Digested tissue is strained to remove debris and washed in
human breast epithelial cell (HBEC) medium (DMEM F/12 supplemented with 10
mM HEPES, 5% FBS, 1 mg/mL BSA, 0.5 µg/mL hydrocortisone, 50 µg mL
Gentamycin, 1 µg/mL ITS–X100) three times. The pellet is resuspended in freezing
medium (5% FBS and 10% DMSO in HBEC medium) and stored in liquid nitrogen.
To assess the effect of a disclosed compound, tumors in mice are
allowed to grow to about 100 mm , typically about 6-18 days post-implantation,
before the animals are randomized into treatment groups (e.g. vehicle, positive
control and various dose levels of the test compound); the number of animals per
group is typically 8-12. Day 1 of study corresponds to the day that the animals
receive their first dose. The efficacy of a test compound can be determined in
studies of various length dependent upon the goals of the study. Typical study
periods are for 14, 21 and 28-days. The dosing frequency (e.g. whether animals are
dosed with test compound daily, every other day, every third day or other
frequencies) is determined for each study depending upon the toxicity and potency
of the test compound. A typical study design would involve dosing daily (M-F) with
the test compound with recovery on the weekend. Throughout the study, tumor
volumes and body weights are measured twice a week. At the end of the study the
animals are euthanized and the tumors harvested and frozen for further analysis.
Alternatively, tumors may be processed immediately for analysis, e.g. fixed in
buffered-formalin, paraffin embedded, and sectioned for hematoxylin/eosin staining
and further immunohistochemical analysis for desired oncology markers.
For example, compounds described herein, or a pharmaceutically
acceptable salt, solvate, polymorph, hydrate and the stereochemically isomeric form
thereof, are expected to show such in vivo effects.
— 128 —
76. PROPHETIC PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITION EXAMPLES
―Active ingredient‖ as used throughout these examples relates to one
or more of the compounds described herein, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt,
solvate, polymorph, hydrate and the stereochemically isomeric form thereof. The
following examples of the formulation of the compounds described herein in tablets,
suspension, injectables and ointments are prophetic.
Typical examples of recipes for the formulation described herein are as
given below. Various other dosage forms can be applied herein such as a filled
gelatin capsule, liquid emulsion/suspension, ointments, suppositories or chewable
tablet form employing the disclosed compounds in desired dosage amounts in
accordance with the present disclosure. Various conventional techniques for
preparing suitable dosage forms can be used to prepare the prophetic
pharmaceutical compositions, such as those disclosed herein and in standard
reference texts, for example the British and US Pharmacopoeias, Remington‘s
Pharmaceutical Sciences (Mack Publishing Co.) and Martindale The Extra
Pharmacopoeia (London The Pharmaceutical Press).
The disclosure of this reference is hereby incorporated herein by
reference.
a. PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITION FOR ORAL ADMINISTRATION
A tablet can be prepared as follows:
Component Amount
Active ingredient 10 to 500 mg
Lactose 100 mg
Crystalline cellulose 60 mg
Magnesium stearate 5
Starch (e.g. potato starch) Amount necessary to yield
total weight indicated below
Total (per capsule) 1000 mg
— 129 —
Alternatively, about 100 mg of a disclosed compound, 50 mg of lactose
(monohydrate), 50 mg of maize starch (native), 10 mg of polyvinylpyrrolidone (PVP
) (e.g. from BASF, Ludwigshafen, Germany) and 2 mg of magnesium stearate are
used per tablet. The mixture of active component, lactose and starch is granulated
with a 5% solution (m/m) of the PVP in water. After drying, the granules are mixed
with magnesium stearate for 5 min. This mixture is moulded using a customary
tablet press (e.g. tablet format: diameter 8 mm, curvature radius 12 mm). The
moulding force applied is typically about 15 kN.
Alternatively, a disclosed compound can be administered in a
suspension formulated for oral use. For example, about 100-5000 mg of the desired
disclosed compound, 1000 mg of ethanol (96%), 400 mg of xanthan gum, and 99 g
of water are combined with stirring. A single dose of about 10-500 mg of the desired
disclosed compound according can be provided by 10 ml of oral suspension.
In these Examples, active ingredient can be replaced with the same
amount of any of the compounds described herein, in particular by the same amount
of any of the exemplified compounds. In some circumstances it may be desirable to
use a capsule, e.g. a filled gelatin capsule, instead of a tablet form. The choice of
tablet or capsule will depend, in part, upon physicochemical characteristics of the
particular disclosed compound used.
Examples of alternative useful carriers for making oral preparations are
lactose, sucrose, starch, talc, magnesium stearate, crystalline cellulose, methyl
cellulose, hydroxypropyl cellulose, hydroxypropylmethyl cellulose, carboxymethyl
cellulose, glycerin, sodium alginate, gum arabic, etc. These alternative carriers can
be substituted for those given above as required for desired dissolution, absorption,
and manufacturing characteristics.
The amount of a disclosed compound per tablet for use in a
pharmaceutical composition for human use is determined from both toxicological
and pharmacokinetic data obtained in suitable animal models, e.g. rat and at least
one non-rodent species, and adjusted based upon human clinical trial data. For
example, it could be appropriate that a disclosed compound is present at a level of
about 10 to 1000 mg per tablet dosage unit.
— 130 —
b. PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITION FOR INJECTABLE USE
A parenteral composition can be prepared as follows:
Component Amount
Active ingredient 10 to 500 mg
Sodium carbonate 560 mg*
Sodium hydroxide 80 mg*
Distilled, sterile water Quantity sufficient to prepare
total volumen indicated below.
Total (per capsule) 10 ml per ampule
* Amount adjusted as required to maintain physiological pH in the
context of the amount of active ingredient, and form of active
ingredient, e.g. a particular salt form of the active ingredient.
Alternatively, a pharmaceutical composition for intravenous injection
can be used, with composition comprising about 100-5000 mg of a disclosed
compound, 15 g polyethylenglycol 400 and 250 g water in saline with optionally up to
about 15% Cremophor EL, and optionally up to 15% ethyl alcohol, and optionally up
to 2 equivalents of a pharmaceutically suitable acid such as citric acid or
hydrochloric acid are used. The preparation of such an injectable composition can
be accomplished as follows: The disclosed compound and the polyethylenglycol
400 are dissolved in the water with stirring. The solution is sterile filtered (pore size
0.22 μm) and filled into heat sterilized infusion bottles under aseptic conditions. The
infusion bottles are sealed with rubber seals.
In a further example, a pharmaceutical composition for intravenous
injection can be used, with composition comprising about 10-500 mg of a disclosed
compound, standard saline solution, optionally with up to 15% by weight of
Cremophor EL, and optionally up to 15% by weight of ethyl alcohol, and optionally
up to 2 equivalents of a pharmaceutically suitable acid such as citric acid or
hydrochloric acid. Preparation can be accomplished as follows: a desired disclosed
compound is dissolved in the saline solution with stirring. Optionally Cremophor EL,
ethyl alcohol or acid are added. The solution is sterile filtered (pore size 0.22 μm)
and filled into heat sterilized infusion bottles under aseptic conditions. The infusion
bottles are sealed with rubber seals.
— 131 —
In this Example, active ingredient can be replaced with the same
amount of any of the compounds described herein, in particular by the same amount
of any of the exemplified compounds.
The amount of a disclosed compound per ampule for use in a
pharmaceutical composition for human use is determined from both toxicological
and pharmacokinetic data obtained in suitable animal models, e.g. rat and at least
one non-rodent species, and adjusted based upon human clinical trial data. For
example, it could be appropriate that a disclosed compound is present at a level of
about 10 to 1000 mg per tablet dosage unit.
Carriers suitable for parenteral preparations are, for example, water,
physiological saline solution, etc. which can be used with
tris(hydroxymethyl)aminomethane, sodium carbonate, sodium hydroxide or the like
serving as a solubilizer or pH adjusting agent. The parenteral preparations contain
preferably 50 to 1000 mg of a disclosed compound per dosage unit.
It will be apparent to those skilled in the art that various modifications
and variations can be made in the present invention without departing from the
scope or spirit of the invention. Other embodiments of the invention will be apparent
to those skilled in the art from consideration of the specification and practice of the
invention disclosed herein. It is intended that the specification and examples be
considered as exemplary only, with a true scope and spirit of the invention being
indicated by the following claims.
In the description in this specification reference may be made to subject
matter that is not within the scope of the claims of the current application. That
subject matter should be readily identifiable by a person skilled in the art and may
assist in putting into practice the invention as defined in the claims of this application.
— 132 —
Claims (23)
1. A compound having a structure represented by a formula: NH m 2 (I), wherein m is 1; n is an integer from 0 to 3; Z is independently selected from N and CH; R is selected from halo, C1-C3 haloalkyl, and C1-C3 polyhaloalkyl; each of R , R , and R is independently selected from hydrogen, halo, hydroxyl, 2 3 4 cyano, amino, C2-C6 alkalkoxy, C1-C6 alkoxy, C1-C6 alkyl, C1-C6 polyhaloalkyl, and C1-C6 haloalkyl; R is selected from NR and Cy, and substituted with 0-3 groups independently selected from halo, hydroxyl, amino, cyano, C2-C6 alkalkoxy, C1-C6 alkylalcohol, C1-C6 alkoxy, C1-C6 alkyl, C1-C6 polyhaloalkyl, C1-C6 haloalkyl, C3-C6 cycloalkyl, and Cy; Cy is a heterocycloalkyl selected from aziridinyl, azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, azepanyl, oxazolidinyl, imidazolidinyl, pyrazolidinyl, piperazinyl, oxazinanyl, morpholinyl, hexahydrophyrimidinyl, and hexahydropyridazinyl; and R is selected from hydrogen, C1-C6 alkyl, C3-C6 cycloalkyl, and C3-C6 heterocycloalkyl; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof. — 133 —
2. The compound of claim 1, wherein R is selected from: R R R 8b 8b 9b R R R 8a 8c 8a 8c 9a N N N R R R 8d 8d R R R 8e , 8e , , , , , , wherein each of R , R , R , R , and R is independently selected from hydrogen, halo, amino, 8a 8b 8c 8d 8e cyano, hydroxyl, C2-C6 alkoxyalkyl, C1-C3 alkoxy, C1-C3 haloalkyl, and C1-C3 polyhaloalkyl, and C1-C6 alkyl, and each of R , R , R , and R is independently selected from hydrogen, amino, halo, 9a 9b 9c 9d hydroxyl, C1-C3 alkyl, C1-C3 alkoxy, C1-C3 haloalkyl, C1-C3 polyhaloalkyl, aziridinyl, azetidinyl, and pyrollidinyl.
3. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of claim 1 and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
4. A use of a compound of claim 1, in the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of a disorder of uncontrolled cellular proliferation in a mammal in need thereof.
5. A use of a compound of claim 1, in the manufacture of a medicament to treat a disease or disorder responsive to decreasing histone demethylase activity in a mammal in need thereof.
6. A compound selected from the group consisting of: — 134 — — 135 — N NH N NH — 136 — F , and or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
7. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of claim 6 and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
8. A use of a compound of claim 6, in the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of a disorder of uncontrolled cellular proliferation in a mammal in need thereof.
9. A compound having a structure represented by a formula: or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
10. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of claim 9 and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
11. A use of a compound of claim 9, in the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of a disorder of uncontrolled cellular proliferation in a mammal in need thereof.
12. A compound having a structure represented by a formula: — 137 — or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
13. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of claim 12 and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
14. A use of a compound of claim 12, in the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of a disorder of uncontrolled cellular proliferation in a mammal in need thereof.
15. A compound having a structure represented by a formula: or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
16. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of claim 15 and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
17. A use of a compound of claim 15, in the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of a disorder of uncontrolled cellular proliferation in a mammal in need thereof.
18. A compound having a structure represented by a formula: or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof. — 138 —
19. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of claim 18, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
20. A use of a compound of claim 18, in the manufacture of a medicament for treatment of a disorder of uncontrolled cellular proliferation in a mammal in need thereof.
21. A compound as claimed in any one of claims 1, 6, 9, 12, 15 and 18, substantially as herein described with reference to any example thereof.
22. A pharmaceutical composition as claimed in any one of claims 3, 7, 10, 13, 16 and 19, substantially as herein described with reference to any example thereof.
23. A use as claimed in any one of claims 4, 5, 8, 11, 14, 17 and 20, substantially has herein described with reference to any example thereof. — 139 —
Applications Claiming Priority (3)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US201161523801P | 2011-08-15 | 2011-08-15 | |
US61/523,801 | 2011-08-15 | ||
PCT/US2012/050948 WO2013025805A1 (en) | 2011-08-15 | 2012-08-15 | Substituted (e)-n'-(1-phenylethylidene) benzohydrazide analogs as histone demethylase inhiitors |
Publications (2)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
NZ621078A NZ621078A (en) | 2015-10-30 |
NZ621078B2 true NZ621078B2 (en) | 2016-02-02 |
Family
ID=
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
EP3010915B1 (en) | Substituted (3-(5-chloro-2-hydroxyphenyl)-1-benzoyl-1h-pyrazole compounds as histone demethylase inhibitors | |
US9555024B2 (en) | Substituted (E)-N′-(1-phenylethylidene)benzohydrazide analogs as histone demethylase inhibitors | |
US20170001970A1 (en) | Substituted benzohydrazide analogs as histone demethylase inhibitors | |
US9556170B2 (en) | Substituted-1H-benzo[d]imidazole series compounds as lysine-specific demethylase 1 (LSD1) inhibitors | |
US9642857B2 (en) | Substituted (E)-N′-(1-phenylethylidene)benzohydrazide analogs as histone demethylase inhibitors | |
US20170283397A1 (en) | Substituted 1-h-indol-3-yl-benzamide and 1, 1'-biphenyl analogs as histone demethylase inhibitors | |
EP3941459A1 (en) | Quinoline and quinazoline compounds and methods of use thereof | |
WO2016067143A1 (en) | N-(2-alkyleneimino-3-phenylpropyl)acetamide compounds and their use against pain and pruritus via inhibition of trpa1 channels | |
CA3106860C (en) | 1-methyl-4-[(4-phenylphenyl)sulfonylmethyl]cyclohexanol and 1-methyl-4-[[4-(2-pyridyl)phenyl]sulfonylmethyl]cyclohexanol compounds and their therapeutic use | |
NZ621078B2 (en) | Substituted (e)-n'-(1-phenylethylidene) benzohydrazide analogs as histone demethylase inhibitors |